blob: 28163cb8506d279ffd42bf23c5211f5f06a9a199 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner216c7b82003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattnerb4cfa7f2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner024f4ab2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000043#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000046#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000047#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000048#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000049#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +000050#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000051#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattner3d27be12006-08-27 12:54:02 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000053#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer7c16caa2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +000058#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +000059#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000060using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000061using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +000062
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000063STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
64STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
65STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnerbf3a0992002-10-01 22:38:41 +000068
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069namespace {
Chris Lattner4a4c7fe2006-06-28 22:08:15 +000070 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
71 : public FunctionPass,
72 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000073 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000074 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
75 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000076 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +000077 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 public:
79 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
80 /// isn't already in it.
81 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
82 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
83 Worklist.push_back(I);
84 }
85
86 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
87 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
88 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
89 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
90
91 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
92 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
93
94 WorklistMap.erase(It);
95 }
96
97 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
98 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
99 Worklist.pop_back();
100 WorklistMap.erase(I);
101 return I;
102 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000103
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000104
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000105 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
106 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
107 /// now.
108 ///
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000109 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000110 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000111 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000112 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000113 }
114
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000115 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
116 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
117 ///
118 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
119 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
120 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000121 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000122 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000123
124 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
125 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
126 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
127 ///
128 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
129 ///
130 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
131 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
132
133 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
134 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000135 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000136 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
137 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
138 }
139
140 return R;
141 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000142
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000143 public:
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000144 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000145
146 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000148 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000149 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000150 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattner820d9712002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000151 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 }
153
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000154 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
155
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000156 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
157 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
158 // Return Value:
159 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000160 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000161 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000162 //
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000163 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
164 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
165 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000166 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
167 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000171 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000176 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000179 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000183 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
184 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
185 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000186 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
187 Instruction *LHS,
188 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000189
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000190 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
191 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000192 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000193 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000194 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
195 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
196 Instruction *visitTrunc(CastInst &CI);
197 Instruction *visitZExt(CastInst &CI);
198 Instruction *visitSExt(CastInst &CI);
199 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
200 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
202 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
203 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
205 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitBitCast(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000208 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
209 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000210 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000211 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000213 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
214 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000215 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000216 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000217 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000218 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000219 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000220 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000221 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000223 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000224
225 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000226 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000227
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000228 private:
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000229 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000230 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
231
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000232 public:
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000233 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
234 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
235 //
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000236 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattner65217ff2002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000237 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
238 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000239 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
240 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000241 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000242 return New;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000243 }
244
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000245 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
246 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
247 /// cast.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000248 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
249 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000250 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000251
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000252 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000253 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000254
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000255 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000256 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000257 return C;
258 }
259
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000260 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
261 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
262 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
263 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
264 // modified.
265 //
266 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000267 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000268 if (&I != V) {
269 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
270 return &I;
271 } else {
272 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
273 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000274 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000275 return &I;
276 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000277 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000278
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000279 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
280 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
281 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
282 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
283 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
284 //
285 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
286 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
287 if (Old != New)
288 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
289 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000290 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000291 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000292 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000293 return true;
294 }
295
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000296 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
297 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
298 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
299 // this function.
300 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
301 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
302 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000303 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner95307542004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000304 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000305 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
306 }
307
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000308 private:
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000309 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
310 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
311 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
312 ///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000313 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
314 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000315 Instruction *InsertBefore);
316
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000317 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
318 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000319 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000320
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000321 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
322 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
323 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
324
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000325 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
326 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000327 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
328 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
329 unsigned Depth = 0);
330
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000331 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
332 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
333
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000334 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
335 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
336 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
337 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
338
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000339 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
340 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
341 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
342 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000343 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
344
345
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000346 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
347 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000348
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000349 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000350 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000351 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000352 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +0000353 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000354 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
355
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000356 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000357 };
Chris Lattnerb28b6802002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000358
Chris Lattnerc2d3d312006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000359 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000360}
361
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000362// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000363// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000364static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
365 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
366 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000367 return 3;
368 return 4;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000369 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000370 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
371 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000372}
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000373
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000374// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
375// it.
376static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000377 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000378}
379
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000380// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
381// though a va_arg area...
382static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000383 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
384 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
385 return Type::Int32Ty;
386 } else if (Ty == Type::FloatTy)
387 return Type::DoubleTy;
388 return Ty;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000389}
390
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000391/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
392/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
393static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
394 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000395 return I->getOperand(0);
396 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000397 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000398 return CE->getOperand(0);
399 return 0;
400}
401
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000402/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
403/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000404static Instruction::CastOps
405isEliminableCastPair(
406 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
407 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
408 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
409 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
410) {
411
412 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
413 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000414
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000415 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
416 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
417 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000418
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000419 return Instruction::CastOps(
420 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
421 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000422}
423
424/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
425/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
426/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000427static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
428 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000429 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
430
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000431 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000432 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000433 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000434 return false;
435 return true;
436}
437
438/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
439/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
440/// casts that are known to not do anything...
441///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000442Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
443 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000444 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
445 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
446 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000447 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000448
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000449 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000450}
451
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000452// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
453// operators:
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000454//
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000455// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
456// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
457// binary operators.
458//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000459// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
460// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000461//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000462bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000463 bool Changed = false;
464 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
465 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000466
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000467 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
468 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000469 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
470 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
471 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000472 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
473 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
474 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000475 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
476 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
477 return true;
478 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
479 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
480 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
481 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
482 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
483
484 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000485 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000486 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
487 Op1->getOperand(0),
488 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000489 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000490 I.setOperand(0, New);
491 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
492 return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000493 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000494 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000495 return Changed;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000496}
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000497
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000498/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
499/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
500/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
501bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
502 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
503 return false;
504 I.swapOperands();
505 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
506 return true;
507}
508
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000509// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
510// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000511//
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000512static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
513 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000514 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000515
Chris Lattner9ad0d552004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000516 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
517 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
518 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000519 return 0;
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000520}
521
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000522static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
523 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000524 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000525
526 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000527 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000528 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000529 return 0;
530}
531
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000532// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
533// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000534// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
535// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000536//
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000537static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000538 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000539 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000540 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000541 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000542 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000543 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000544 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000545 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng4961cf12007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000546 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000547 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng4961cf12007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000548 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000549 return I->getOperand(0);
550 }
551 }
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000552 return 0;
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000553}
Chris Lattner31ae8632002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000554
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000555/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
556/// expression, return it.
557static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
558 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
559 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
560 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
561 return cast<User>(V);
562 return false;
563}
564
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000565/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000566static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000567 APInt Val(C->getValue());
568 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000569}
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000570/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000571static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000572 APInt Val(C->getValue());
573 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000574}
575/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
576static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
577 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
578}
579/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
580static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
581 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
582}
583/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
584static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
585 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
586}
587/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
588static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
589 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000590}
591
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000592/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
593/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000594/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
595/// processing.
596/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
597/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
598/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
599/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
600/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
601/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000602static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000603 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000604 assert(V && "No Value?");
605 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000606 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000607 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000608 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000609 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000610 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000611 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
612 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000613 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000614 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
615 return;
616 }
617
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000618 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
619 return; // Limit search depth.
620
621 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
622 if (!I) return;
623
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000624 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000625 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000626
627 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000628 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000629 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
630 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000631 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
632 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000633 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
634 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
635
636 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
637 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
638 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
639 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
640 return;
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000641 }
642 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000643 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000644 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
645 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000646 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
647 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
648
649 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
650 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
651 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
652 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
653 return;
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000654 }
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000655 case Instruction::Xor: {
656 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
657 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
658 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
659 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
660
661 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
662 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
663 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
664 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
665 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
666 return;
667 }
668 case Instruction::Select:
669 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
670 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
671 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
672 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
673
674 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
675 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
676 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
677 return;
678 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
679 case Instruction::FPExt:
680 case Instruction::FPToUI:
681 case Instruction::FPToSI:
682 case Instruction::SIToFP:
683 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
684 case Instruction::UIToFP:
685 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
686 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000687 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000688 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000689 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
690 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000691 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
692 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
693 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
694 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
695 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
697 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000698 return;
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000699 }
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000700 case Instruction::BitCast: {
701 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
702 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
703 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
704 return;
705 }
706 break;
707 }
708 case Instruction::ZExt: {
709 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
710 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000711 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000712
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000713 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
714 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
715 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
716 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
717 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000718 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
719 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000720 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
721 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000722 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000723 return;
724 }
725 case Instruction::SExt: {
726 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
727 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000728 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000729
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000730 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
731 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
732 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
733 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
734 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000735 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000736 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
737 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000738
739 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
740 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000741 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng117477e2007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000742 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000743 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng117477e2007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000744 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000745 return;
746 }
747 case Instruction::Shl:
748 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
749 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000750 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000751 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
752 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000753 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Shengb3e00c42007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000754 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
755 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000756 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000757 return;
758 }
759 break;
760 case Instruction::LShr:
761 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
762 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
763 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000764 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000765
766 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000767 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
768 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000769 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
770 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
771 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000772 // high bits known zero.
773 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000774 return;
775 }
776 break;
777 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000778 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000779 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
780 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000781 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000782
783 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000784 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
785 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000786 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
787 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
788 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
789
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000790 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
791 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000792 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000793 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000794 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000795 return;
796 }
797 break;
798 }
799}
800
Reid Spencerbb5741f2007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000801/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
802/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
803/// for bits that V cannot have.
804static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengbe171ee2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000805 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencerbb5741f2007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000806 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
807 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
808 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
809}
810
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000811/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
812/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
813/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
814/// constant and return true.
815static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencerd9281782007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000816 APInt Demanded) {
817 assert(I && "No instruction?");
818 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
819
820 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
821 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
822 if (!OpC) return false;
823
824 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
825 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
826 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
827 return false;
828
829 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
830 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
831 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
832 return true;
833}
834
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000835// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
836// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
837// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
838// min/max.
839static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000840 const APInt& KnownZero,
841 const APInt& KnownOne,
842 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
843 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
844 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
845 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
846 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
847 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000848 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000849
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000850 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
851 // bit if it is unknown.
852 Min = KnownOne;
853 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
854
Zhou Shengc2d33092007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000855 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000856 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
857 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858 }
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000859}
860
861// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
862// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
863// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
864// min/max.
865static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000866 const APInt& KnownZero,
867 const APInt& KnownOne,
868 APInt& Min,
869 APInt& Max) {
870 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
871 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
872 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
873 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
874 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000875 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000876
877 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
878 Min = KnownOne;
879 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
880 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
881}
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000882
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000883/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
884/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
885/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
886/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
887/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
888/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
889/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
890/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
891/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
892/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
893/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
894/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
895/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
896/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
897/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
898bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
899 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
900 unsigned Depth) {
901 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
902 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
903 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
904 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
905 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
906 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
907 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
908 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
909 must have same BitWidth");
910 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
911 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
912 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
913 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
914 return false;
915 }
916
Zhou Shengb9128442007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000917 KnownZero.clear();
918 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000919 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
920 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
921 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
922 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
923 return false;
924 }
925 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
926 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
927 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
928 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
929 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
930 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
931 return false;
932 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
933 return false;
934 }
935
936 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
937 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
938
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000939 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
940 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
941 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
942 default: break;
943 case Instruction::And:
944 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
945 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
946 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
947 return true;
948 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
949 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
950
951 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
952 // LHS.
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
954 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
957 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
958
959 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
960 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
961 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
962 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
963 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
964 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
965 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
966 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
967
968 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
969 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
970 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
971
972 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
973 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
974 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
975
976 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
977 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
978 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
979 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
980 break;
981 case Instruction::Or:
982 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
983 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
984 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
985 return true;
986 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
987 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
988 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
989 // LHS.
990 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
991 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
992 return true;
993 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
994 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
995
996 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
997 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
998 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
999 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1000 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1001 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1002 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1003 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1004
1005 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1006 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1007 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1008 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1009 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1010 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1011 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1012 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1013
1014 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1015 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1016 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1017
1018 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1019 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1020 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1021 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1022 break;
1023 case Instruction::Xor: {
1024 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1025 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1026 return true;
1027 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1028 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1031 return true;
1032 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1033 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1034
1035 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1036 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1037 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1038 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1039 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1040 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1041
1042 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1043 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1044 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1045 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1046 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1047 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1048
1049 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1050 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1051 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1052 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1053 Instruction *Or =
1054 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1055 I->getName());
1056 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1057 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1058 }
1059
1060 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1061 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1062 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1063 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1064 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1065 // all known
1066 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1067 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1068 Instruction *And =
1069 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1070 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1071 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1072 }
1073 }
1074
1075 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1076 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1077 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1078 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1079
1080 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1081 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1082 break;
1083 }
1084 case Instruction::Select:
1085 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1086 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1087 return true;
1088 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1089 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1090 return true;
1091 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1092 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1093 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1094 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1095
1096 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1097 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1098 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1099 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1100 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1101
1102 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1103 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1104 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1105 break;
1106 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1107 uint32_t truncBf =
1108 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001109 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1110 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1111 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1112 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1113 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001114 return true;
1115 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1116 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1117 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1118 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1119 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1120 break;
1121 }
1122 case Instruction::BitCast:
1123 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1124 return false;
1125
1126 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1127 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1128 return true;
1129 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1130 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1131 break;
1132 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1133 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1134 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001135 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001136
Zhou Sheng444af492007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001137 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1138 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1139 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001140 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1141 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001142 return true;
1143 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1144 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1145 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1146 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1147 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1148 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001149 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 break;
1151 }
1152 case Instruction::SExt: {
1153 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1154 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001155 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001156
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001157 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001158 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001159
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001160 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001161 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1162 // bit is demanded.
1163 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001164 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165
Zhou Sheng444af492007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001166 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1167 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1168 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001169 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1170 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001171 return true;
1172 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1173 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1174 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1175 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1176 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1177
1178 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1179 // top bits of the result.
1180
1181 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1182 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001183 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001184 {
1185 // Convert to ZExt cast
1186 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1187 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001188 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001189 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001190 }
1191 break;
1192 }
1193 case Instruction::Add: {
1194 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1195 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1196 // either.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001197 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001198
1199 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1200 // we can do.
1201 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1202 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1203 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1204 if (RHS->isZero())
1205 break;
1206
1207 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1208 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001209 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001210
1211 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1212 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1213 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1214 return true;
1215
1216 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1217 // the constant.
1218 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1219 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1220
1221 // Avoid excess work.
1222 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1223 break;
1224
1225 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1226 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1227 Instruction *Or =
1228 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1229 I->getName());
1230 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1231 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1232 }
1233
1234 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1235 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1236 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1237 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1238 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1239
1240 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1241 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1242 // this scan.
Zhou Sheng4f164022007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001243 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1244 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245
1246 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1247
1248 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1249 // other, and there is no input carry.
1250 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1251 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1252
1253 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1254 // is no input carry.
1255 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1256 } else {
1257 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1258 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001259 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001260 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1261 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001262 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001263 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1264 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1265 return true;
1266 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1267 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1268 return true;
1269 }
1270 }
1271 break;
1272 }
1273 case Instruction::Sub:
1274 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1275 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001276 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001277 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1278 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001279 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001280 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001281 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1282 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1283 return true;
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287 }
1288 break;
1289 case Instruction::Shl:
1290 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001291 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001292 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1293 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001294 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1295 return true;
1296 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1297 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1298 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1299 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1300 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001301 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001302 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001303 }
1304 break;
1305 case Instruction::LShr:
1306 // For a logical shift right
1307 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001308 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001309
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001310 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001311 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1312 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1314 return true;
1315 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1316 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1318 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001319 if (ShiftAmt) {
1320 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001321 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001322 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1323 }
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001324 }
1325 break;
1326 case Instruction::AShr:
1327 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1328 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1329 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1330 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1331 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1332 // Perform the logical shift right.
1333 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1334 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1335 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1336 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1337 }
1338
1339 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001340 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001341
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001342 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001343 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001344 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001345 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001346 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1347 return true;
1348 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1349 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1350 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001351 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001352 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1353 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1354
1355 // Handle the sign bits.
1356 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1357 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1358 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1359
1360 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1361 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001362 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001363 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1364 // Perform the logical shift right.
1365 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1366 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1367 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1368 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1369 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1370 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1371 }
1372 }
1373 break;
1374 }
1375
1376 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1377 // constant.
1378 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1379 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1380 return false;
1381}
1382
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001383
1384/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1385/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1386/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1387/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1388///
1389/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1390/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1391/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1392Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1393 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1394 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001395 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001396 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1397 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1398 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1399 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1400
1401 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1402 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1403 UndefElts = EltMask;
1404 return 0;
1405 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1406 UndefElts = EltMask;
1407 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1408 }
1409
1410 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1412 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001413 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1414
1415 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1416 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1417 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1418 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1419 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1420 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1421 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1422 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1423 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1424 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1425 }
1426
1427 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001428 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1430 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001431 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001432 // set to undef.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001433 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001434 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1435 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1436 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1437 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1438 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1439 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001440 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001441 }
1442
1443 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1444 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1445 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1446 return false;
1447 }
1448 return false;
1449 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1450 return false;
1451 }
1452
1453 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1454 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1455
1456 bool MadeChange = false;
1457 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1458 Value *TmpV;
1459 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1460 default: break;
1461
1462 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1463 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1464 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001465 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001466 if (Idx == 0) {
1467 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1468 // which elt is getting updated.
1469 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1470 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1471 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1472 break;
1473 }
1474
1475 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1476 // insertelement.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001477 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001478 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1479 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1480
1481 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1482 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1483 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1484 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1485 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1486 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1487
1488 // The inserted element is defined.
1489 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1490 break;
1491 }
1492
1493 case Instruction::And:
1494 case Instruction::Or:
1495 case Instruction::Xor:
1496 case Instruction::Add:
1497 case Instruction::Sub:
1498 case Instruction::Mul:
1499 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1500 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1501 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1502 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1503 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1504 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1505 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1506
1507 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1508 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1509 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1510 break;
1511
1512 case Instruction::Call: {
1513 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1514 if (!II) break;
1515 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1516 default: break;
1517
1518 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1519 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1520 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1521 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1522 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1523 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1524 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1525 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1526 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1527 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1528 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1529 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1530 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1531 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1532 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1533 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1534
1535 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1536 // scalarize it now.
1537 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1538 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1539 default: break;
1540 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1541 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1542 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1543 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1544 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1545 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1546 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1547 // Extract the element as scalars.
1548 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1549 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1550
1551 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1552 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1553 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1554 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1555 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1556 II->getName()), *II);
1557 break;
1558 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1559 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1560 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1561 II->getName()), *II);
1562 break;
1563 }
1564
1565 Instruction *New =
1566 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1567 II->getName());
1568 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1569 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1570 return New;
1571 }
1572 }
1573
1574 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1575 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1576 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1577 break;
1578 }
1579 break;
1580 }
1581 }
1582 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1583}
1584
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001585/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1586/// true when both operands are equal...
1587/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true if both operands are equal
1588static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1589 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = ICI.getPredicate();
1590 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1591 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1592 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1593}
1594
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001595/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1596/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1597/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1598/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1599/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1600/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1601/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1602///
1603template<typename Functor>
1604Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1605 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1606 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1607
1608 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1609 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1610 return F.apply(Root);
1611
1612 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1613 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001614 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001615 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1616 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1617
1618 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1619 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1620 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1621 ShouldApply = true;
1622 }
1623
1624 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1625 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1626 if (ShouldApply) {
1627 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001628
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001629 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1630 // and perform the reassociation.
1631 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1632
1633 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1634 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1635
1636 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1637 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001638 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001639 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1640 return 0;
1641 }
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001642 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001643 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001644 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1645 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1646 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1647 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001648
1649 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1650 // get to LHSI.
1651 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1652 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001653 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1654 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1655 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1656 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1657 ARI = NextLHSI;
1658
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001659 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1660 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1661 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1662 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1663 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001664
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001665 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1666 // the transformation...
1667 return F.apply(Root);
1668 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001669
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001670 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1671 }
1672 return 0;
1673}
1674
1675
1676// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1677struct AddRHS {
1678 Value *RHS;
1679 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1680 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1681 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001682 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001683 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001684 }
1685};
1686
1687// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1688// iff C1&C2 == 0
1689struct AddMaskingAnd {
1690 Constant *C2;
1691 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1692 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001693 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001694 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001695 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001696 }
1697 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001698 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001699 }
1700};
1701
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001702static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001703 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001704 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001705 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001706 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001707
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001708 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1709 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001710 }
1711
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001712 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001713 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1714 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001715
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001716 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1717 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001718 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1719 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001720 }
1721
1722 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1723 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1724 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1725 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001726 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1727 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001728 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1729 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1730 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001731 else {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001732 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001733 abort();
1734 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001735 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1736}
1737
1738// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1739// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1740// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1741// not have a second operand.
1742static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1743 InstCombiner *IC) {
1744 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1745 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1746 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1747 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1748
1749 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001750 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001751 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001752
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001753 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1754 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1755
1756 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1757 SelectFalseVal);
1758 }
1759 return 0;
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001760}
1761
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001762
1763/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1764/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1765/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1766Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1767 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001768 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001769 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001770
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001771 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1772 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerc4d8e7e2007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001773 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001774 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1775 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1776 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1777 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerc4d8e7e2007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001778 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001779 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1780
1781 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1782 // loop.
1783 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1784 return 0;
1785 }
1786
1787 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1788 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1789 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1790 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1791 if (NonConstBB) {
1792 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1793 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1794 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001795
1796 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001797 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001798 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001799 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001800 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001801
1802 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1803 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1804 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001805 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001806 Value *InV;
1807 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001808 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1809 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1810 else
1811 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001812 } else {
1813 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1814 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1815 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1816 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1817 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001818 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1819 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1820 CI->getPredicate(),
1821 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1822 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001823 else
1824 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1825
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001826 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001827 }
1828 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001829 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001830 } else {
1831 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1832 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001833 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001834 Value *InV;
1835 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001836 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001837 } else {
1838 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001839 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1840 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1841 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001842 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001843 }
1844 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001845 }
1846 }
1847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1848}
1849
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001850Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001851 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001852 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001853
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001854 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001855 // X + undef -> undef
1856 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1858
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001859 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001860 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001861 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattnerda1b1522005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001863 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1864 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001866 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001867
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001868 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001869 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001870 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001871 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001872 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001873 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001874
1875 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1876 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001877 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1878 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1880 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1881 return &I;
1882 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001883 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001884
1885 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1886 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1887 return NV;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001888
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001889 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1890 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001891 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1892 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001893 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001894 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001895
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001896 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001897 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1898 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001899 do {
1900 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001901 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1902 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001903 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1904 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001905 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001906 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1907 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001908 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001909 break;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001910 }
1911 }
1912 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001913 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1914 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1915 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001916
Reid Spencera5c18bf2007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001917 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
1918 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
1919 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
1920 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
1921 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1922 switch (Size) {
1923 default: break;
1924 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1925 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1926 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1927 }
1928 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001929 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001930 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencera5c18bf2007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001931 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001932 }
1933 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001934 }
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001935
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001936 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00001937 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001938 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00001939
1940 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
1941 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1942 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
1943 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
1944 }
1945 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
1946 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1947 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
1948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
1949 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00001950 }
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00001951
Chris Lattner147e9752002-05-08 22:46:53 +00001952 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001953 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001954 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001955
1956 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001957 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
1958 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001959 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001960
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001961
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001962 ConstantInt *C2;
1963 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
1964 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
1965 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
1966
1967 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
1968 ConstantInt *C1;
1969 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001970 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001971 }
1972
1973 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001974 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
1975 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
1976
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001977 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
1978 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
1979 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
1980 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
1981
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001982
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001983 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001984 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001985 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
1986 return R;
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +00001987
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00001988 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001989 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001990 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
1991 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001992
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001993 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
1994 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001995 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001996 if (Anded == CRHS) {
1997 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
1998 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001999 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002000
2001 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002002 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002003
2004 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002005 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002006
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002007 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2008 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2009 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2010 LHS->getName()), I);
2011 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2012 }
2013 }
2014 }
2015
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002016 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2017 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002018 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002019 return R;
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002020 }
2021
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002022 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2023 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2024 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002025 {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002026 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2027 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002028 if (!CI) {
2029 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2030 Other = LHS;
2031 }
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002032 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002033 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2034 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002035 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002036 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002037 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002038 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002039 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002040 }
2041 }
2042
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002043 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002044}
2045
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002046// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2047// highest order bit set.
2048static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002049 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002050 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002051}
2052
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002053Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002054 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002055
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002056 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2057 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002058
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002059 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002060 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002061 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002062
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002063 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2064 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2065 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2067
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002068 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2069 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002070 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2071 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002072
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002073 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002074 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002075 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002076 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2077
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002078 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2079 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002080 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002081 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002082 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002083 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002084 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002085 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002086 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002087 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002088 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2089 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002090 }
2091 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002092 }
2093 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2094 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2095 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002096 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002097 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002098 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002099 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002100 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002101 }
2102 }
2103 }
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002104 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002105
2106 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2107 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002108 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002109 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002110
2111 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2112 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2113 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002114 }
2115
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002116 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2117 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002118 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002119 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002120 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002121 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002122 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002123 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2124 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2125 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002126 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002127 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2128 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002129 }
2130
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002131 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002132 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2133 // is not used by anyone else...
2134 //
Chris Lattnerc2f0aa52004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002135 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002136 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002137 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2138 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2139 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2140 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002141
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002142 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002143 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002144 }
2145
2146 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2147 //
2148 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2149 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2150 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2151
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002152 Value *NewNot =
2153 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002154 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002155 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002156
Reid Spencer3c514952006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002157 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002158 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002159 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002160 if (CSI->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002161 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002162 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002163 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2164
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002165 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002166 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002167 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002168 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002169 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002170 }
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002171 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002172 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002173
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002174 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002175 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2176 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002177 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2179 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2180 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002181 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2182 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2183 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002184 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002185
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002186 ConstantInt *C1;
2187 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002188 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2189 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002190
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002191 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2192 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002193 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002194 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002195 return 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002196}
2197
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002198/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if it
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002199/// really just returns true if the most significant (sign) bit is set.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002200static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS) {
2201 switch (pred) {
2202 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
2203 // True if LHS s< RHS and RHS == 0
2204 return RHS->isNullValue();
2205 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
2206 // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2207 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
2208 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2209 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002210 return RHS->getValue() ==
2211 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2213 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002214 return RHS->getValue() ==
2215 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002216 default:
2217 return false;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002218 }
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002219}
2220
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002221Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002222 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002223 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002224
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002225 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2226 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2227
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002228 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002229 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2230 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002231
2232 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002233 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002234 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2235 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002236 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2237 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002238
Chris Lattnercce81be2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002239 if (CI->isNullValue())
2240 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2241 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2242 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2243 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner35236d82003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002244 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002245
Zhou Sheng4961cf12007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002246 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002247 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002248 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002249 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002250 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002251 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002252 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002254
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002255 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2256 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2257 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
2258 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2259 }
Chris Lattner32c01df2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002260
2261 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2262 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2263 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2264 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2265 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2266 Op1, "tmp");
2267 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2268 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2269 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2270 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2271
2272 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002273
2274 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2275 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002276 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002277 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002278
2279 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2280 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2281 return NV;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002282 }
2283
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002284 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2285 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002286 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002287
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002288 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2289 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2290 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2291 // formed.
2292 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002293 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002294 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002295 BoolCast = CI;
2296 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002297 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002298 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002299 BoolCast = CI;
2300 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002301 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002302 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2303 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
2304
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002305 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002306 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2307 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002308 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002309 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002310 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002311 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002312 Value *V =
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002313 InsertNewInstBefore(
2314 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002315 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2316 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002317
2318 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2319 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002320 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002321 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2322 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002323 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2324 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2325 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2326 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2327 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002328
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002329 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002330 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002331 }
2332 }
2333 }
2334
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002335 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002336}
2337
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002338/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2339/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2340/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2341/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002342Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002343 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002344
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002345 // undef / X -> 0
2346 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002348
2349 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002350 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002352
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002353 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002354 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2355 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002356 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2357 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002358 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002359 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002360 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2361 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2362 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2363 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002364 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002365 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2366 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2367 else
2368 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2369 return &I;
2370 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002371
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002372 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2373 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2374 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2375 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2376 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002377 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002378 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2379 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2380 else
2381 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2382 return &I;
2383 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002384 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002385
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002386 return 0;
2387}
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002388
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002389/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2390/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2391/// division instructions.
2392/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002393Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002394 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2395
2396 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2397 return Common;
2398
2399 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2400 // div X, 1 == X
2401 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2403
2404 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2405 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2406 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2407 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2408 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002409 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattner42362612005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002410 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002411
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002412 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002413 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2414 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2415 return R;
2416 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2417 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2418 return NV;
2419 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002420 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002421
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002422 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002423 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002424 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2425 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2426
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002427 return 0;
2428}
2429
2430Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2431 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2432
2433 // Handle the integer div common cases
2434 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2435 return Common;
2436
2437 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2438 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2439 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2440 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002441 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002442 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002443 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002444 }
2445
2446 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002447 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002448 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2449 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002450 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002451 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002452 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002453 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002454 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002455 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2456 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002457 }
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002458 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002459 }
2460 }
Chris Lattnerdd0c1742005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002461 }
2462
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002463 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2464 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002465 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002466 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002467 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002468 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002469 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002470 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002471 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002472 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2473 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2474 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2475 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2476 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2477
2478 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2479 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2480 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2481 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2482 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002483
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002484 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2485 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002486 }
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002487 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002488 return 0;
2489}
2490
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002491Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2492 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2493
2494 // Handle the integer div common cases
2495 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2496 return Common;
2497
2498 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2499 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2500 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2501 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2502
2503 // -X/C -> X/-C
2504 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2505 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2506 }
2507
2508 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2509 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002510 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002511 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002512 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2513 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2514 }
2515 }
2516
2517 return 0;
2518}
2519
2520Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2521 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2522}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002523
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002524/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2525/// of some factor, return that factor.
2526static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2527 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2528 return CI;
2529
2530 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2531 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2532
2533 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2534 if (!I) return Result;
2535
2536 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2537 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2538 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2539 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2540 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2541 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2542 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2543 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2544 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2545 }
2546 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2547 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2548 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002549 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002550 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2551 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002552 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002553 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002554 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002555 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002556 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2557 return Result;
2558 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2559 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002560 }
2561 return Result;
2562}
2563
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002564/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2565/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2566/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2567/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2568Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002569 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002570
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002571 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2572 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2573 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2574 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2575
2576 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2578 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002580
2581 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2582 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2583 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2584 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2585 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2586 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2587 // simplified also.
2588 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2589 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2590 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2591 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002592 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002593 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2594 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2595 else
2596 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002597 return &I;
2598 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002599 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2600 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2601 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2602 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2603 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002604 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002605 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2606 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2607 else
2608 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2609 return &I;
2610 }
Chris Lattnere9ff0ea2005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002611 }
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002612
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002613 return 0;
2614}
2615
2616/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2617/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2618/// remainder instructions.
2619/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2620Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2621 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2622
2623 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2624 return common;
2625
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002626 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002627 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2628 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2629 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2630
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002631 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2633
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002634 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2635 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2636 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2637 return R;
2638 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2639 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2640 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002641 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002642 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2643 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002645 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002646 }
2647
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002648 return 0;
2649}
2650
2651Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2652 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2653
2654 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2655 return common;
2656
2657 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2658 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2659 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2660 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2661 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002662 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002663 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2664 }
2665
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002666 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002667 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2668 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2669 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002670 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002671 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2672 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2673 "tmp"), I);
2674 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2675 }
2676 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002677 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002678
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002679 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2680 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2681 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2682 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2683 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2684 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002685 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2686 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002687 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2688 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2689 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2690 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2691 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2692 }
2693 }
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002694 }
2695
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002696 return 0;
2697}
2698
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002699Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2700 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2701
2702 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2703 return common;
2704
2705 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2706 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002707 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002708 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2709 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2710 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2711 return &I;
2712 }
2713
2714 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2715 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002716 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002717 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2718 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2719 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2720 }
2721
2722 return 0;
2723}
2724
2725Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002726 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2727}
2728
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002729// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002730static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002731 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002732 if (isSigned) {
2733 // Calculate 0111111111..11111
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002734 APInt Val(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits));
2735 return C->getValue() == Val-1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002736 }
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002737 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002738}
2739
2740// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002741static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
2742 if (isSigned) {
2743 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
Reid Spencer3b93db72007-03-19 21:08:07 +00002744 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2745 APInt Val(APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits));
2746 return C->getValue() == Val+1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002747 }
Reid Spencer3b93db72007-03-19 21:08:07 +00002748 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002749}
2750
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002751// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2752// constant.
2753static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer66827212007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002754 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002755}
2756
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002757// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2758// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2759static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Shengb3949342007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002760 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002761}
2762
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002763/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002764/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2765///
2766/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2767///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002768/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2769/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002770///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002771/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2772/// 0 A > B
2773/// 1 A == B
2774/// 2 A < B
2775///
2776/// <=> Value Definition
2777/// 000 0 Always false
2778/// 001 1 A > B
2779/// 010 2 A == B
2780/// 011 3 A >= B
2781/// 100 4 A < B
2782/// 101 5 A != B
2783/// 110 6 A <= B
2784/// 111 7 Always true
2785///
2786static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2787 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002788 // False -> 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002789 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2790 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2791 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2792 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2793 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2794 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2797 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2798 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002799 // True -> 7
2800 default:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002801 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002802 return 0;
2803 }
2804}
2805
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002806/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2807/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2808/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2809/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2810static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2811 switch (code) {
2812 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002813 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002814 case 1:
2815 if (sign)
2816 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2817 else
2818 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2819 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2820 case 3:
2821 if (sign)
2822 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2823 else
2824 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2825 case 4:
2826 if (sign)
2827 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2828 else
2829 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2830 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2831 case 6:
2832 if (sign)
2833 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2834 else
2835 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002836 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002837 }
2838}
2839
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002840static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2841 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2842 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2843 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2844 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2845 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2846}
2847
2848namespace {
2849// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2850struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002851 InstCombiner &IC;
2852 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002853 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2854 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2855 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2856 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002857 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002858 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2859 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2860 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2861 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002862 return false;
2863 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002864 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2865 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2866 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2867 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2868 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002869 }
2870
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002871 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002872 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002873 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002874 unsigned Code;
2875 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2876 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2877 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2878 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner2caaaba2003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002879 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002880 }
2881
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002882 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2883 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2884
2885 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002886 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2887 return I;
2888 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2889 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2890 }
2891};
Chris Lattnere3a63d12006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002892} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002893
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002894// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2895// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002896// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002897Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002898 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2899 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002900 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2901 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerfcf21a72004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002902 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002903 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002904 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002905
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002906 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
2907 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002908 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002909 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002910 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002911 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002912 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002913 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002914 }
2915 break;
2916 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002917 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
2918 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002919
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002920 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
2921 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002922 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002923 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002924 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002925 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002926 }
2927 break;
2928 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002929 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002930 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
2931 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
2932 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002933 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002934
2935 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002936 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002937 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
2938 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
2939 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002940 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002941
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002942 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
2943 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
2944 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
2945 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
2946 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
2947 // no effect.
2948 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
2949 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
2950 return &TheAnd;
2951 } else {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002952 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002953 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002954 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002955 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002956 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002957 }
2958 }
2959 }
2960 }
2961 break;
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002962
2963 case Instruction::Shl: {
2964 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2965 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
2966 //
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002967 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00002968 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002969 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
2970 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002971
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002972 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
2973 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
2975 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002976 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
2977 return &TheAnd;
2978 }
2979 break;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002980 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002981 case Instruction::LShr:
2982 {
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002983 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2984 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
2985 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
2986 //
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002987 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00002988 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002989 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
2990 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002991
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002992 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
2993 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
2995 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
2996 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
2997 return &TheAnd;
2998 }
2999 break;
3000 }
3001 case Instruction::AShr:
3002 // Signed shr.
3003 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3004 // with an and.
3005 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003006 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003007 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003008 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3009 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003010 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003011 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003012 // Make the argument unsigned.
3013 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003014 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003015 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003016 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003017 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003018 }
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003019 }
3020 break;
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003021 }
3022 return 0;
3023}
3024
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003025
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003026/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3027/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003028/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3029/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003030/// insert new instructions.
3031Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003032 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3033 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003034 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003035 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003036 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003037
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003038 if (Inside) {
3039 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003040 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003041
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003042 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003043 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003044 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003045 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3046 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3047 }
3048
3049 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3050 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3051 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003052 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003053 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3054 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003055 }
3056
3057 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003058 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003059
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003060 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003061 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003062 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003063 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3064 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3065 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3066 }
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003067
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003068 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3069 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3070 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003071 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003072 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003073 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3074 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003075}
3076
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003077// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3078// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3079// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3080// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003081static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003082 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003083 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3084 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003085
3086 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003087 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003088 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003089 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003090 return true;
3091}
3092
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003093/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3094/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3095/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003096///
3097/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3098/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3099/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3100///
3101/// return (A +/- B).
3102///
3103Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003104 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003105 Instruction &I) {
3106 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3107 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3108 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3109
3110 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3111
3112 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3113 default: return 0;
3114 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003115 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003116 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003117 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3118 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3119 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003120 break;
3121
3122 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3123 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3124 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003125 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003126 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003127 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003128 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003129 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003130 break;
3131 }
3132 }
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003133 return 0;
3134 case Instruction::Or:
3135 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003136 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003137 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3138 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003139 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003140 break;
3141 return 0;
3142 }
3143
3144 Instruction *New;
3145 if (isSub)
3146 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3147 else
3148 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3149 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3150}
3151
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003152Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003153 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003154 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003155
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003156 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3157 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3158
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003159 // and X, X = X
3160 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003162
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003163 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003164 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003165 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003166 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3167 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3168 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003169 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003170 return &I;
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003171 } else {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003172 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003173 if (CP->isAllOnesValue())
3174 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
3175 }
3176 }
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003177
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003178 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003179 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3180 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003181
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003182 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003183 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003184 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003185 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3186 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3187 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3188 case Instruction::Xor:
3189 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003190 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3191 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3192 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3193 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3194 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3195 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3196 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3197 return BinaryOperator::create(
3198 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003199 }
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003200 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003201 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3202 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3203 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3204 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3205 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3206 return BinaryOperator::create(
3207 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3208 }
3209 }
3210
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003211 break;
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003212 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003213 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3214 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3215 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3216 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3217 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3218 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3219 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003220 break;
3221
3222 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003223 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3224 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3225 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3226 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3227 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003228 break;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003229 }
3230
Chris Lattner16464b32003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003231 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003232 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003233 return Res;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003234 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003235 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3236 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3237 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3238 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003239 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003240 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnerab2dc4d2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003241 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003242 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3243 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003244 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3245 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3246 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003247 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3248 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3249 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003250 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003251 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003252 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003253 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003254 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3255 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3256 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3257 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner2dc148e2006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003258 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003259 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3261 }
3262 }
Chris Lattner33217db2003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003263 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003264
3265 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3266 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003267 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003268 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003269 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3270 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3271 return NV;
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003272 }
3273
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003274 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3275 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003276
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003277 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3278 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3279
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003280 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003281 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003282 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3283 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003284 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003285 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3286 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003287
3288 {
3289 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003290 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3291 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3292 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3293 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3294 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3295 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003296
3297 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3298 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3299 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3300 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3301 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3302 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3303 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3304 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3305 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3306 }
3307 }
3308 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3309 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3310 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3311 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3312 std::swap(A, B);
3313 }
3314 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3315 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3316 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3317 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3318 }
3319 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003320 }
3321
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003322 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3323 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3324 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003325 return R;
3326
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003327 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3328 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003329 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3330 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3331 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3332 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3333 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3334 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3335 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3336 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3337 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003338 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003339 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3340 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3341 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3342 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003343 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003344 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3345 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3346 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3347 }
3348
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003349 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003350 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3351 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003352 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3353 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3354 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003355 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3356
3357 switch (LHSCC) {
3358 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003359 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003360 switch (RHSCC) {
3361 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003362 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3363 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3364 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003366 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3367 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3368 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3370 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003371 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003372 switch (RHSCC) {
3373 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003374 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3375 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3376 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3377 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3378 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3379 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3380 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3381 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3382 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3383 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3384 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003385 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003386 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3387 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003388 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3389 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3390 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3391 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerc8fb6de2007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003392 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3393 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003394 }
3395 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3396 }
3397 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003398 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003399 switch (RHSCC) {
3400 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003401 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3402 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003403 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003404 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3405 break;
3406 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3407 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003409 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3410 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003411 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003412 break;
3413 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003414 switch (RHSCC) {
3415 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003416 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3417 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003418 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003419 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3420 break;
3421 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3422 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003423 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003424 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3425 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003426 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003427 break;
3428 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3429 switch (RHSCC) {
3430 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3431 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3432 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3433 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3434 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3435 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3436 break;
3437 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3438 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3439 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3440 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3441 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3442 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3443 true, I);
3444 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3445 break;
3446 }
3447 break;
3448 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3449 switch (RHSCC) {
3450 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3451 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3452 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3453 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3454 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3455 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3456 break;
3457 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3458 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3459 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3460 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3461 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3462 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3463 true, I);
3464 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3465 break;
3466 }
3467 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003468 }
3469 }
3470 }
3471
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003472 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003473 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3474 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3475 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3476 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003477 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003478 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003479 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3480 I.getType(), TD) &&
3481 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3482 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003483 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3484 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3485 I.getName());
3486 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3487 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3488 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003489 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003490
3491 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003492 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3493 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3494 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003495 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3496 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3497 Instruction *NewOp =
3498 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3499 SI1->getOperand(0),
3500 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003501 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3502 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003503 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003504 }
3505
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003506 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003507}
3508
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003509/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3510/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3511/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003512static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003513 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3514 if (I == 0) return true;
3515
3516 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3517 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3518 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3519 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3520
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003521 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003522 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3523 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003524 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003525 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003526 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003527 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3528 return true;
3529
3530 unsigned DestNo;
3531 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3532 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3533 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3534 } else {
3535 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3536 DestNo = 0;
3537 }
3538
3539 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3540 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3541 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3542 return true;
3543 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3544 return false;
3545 }
3546
3547 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3548 // don't have this.
3549 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3550 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3551 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3552 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3553 return true;
3554 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3555
3556 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003557 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3558 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003559 return true;
3560
3561 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3562 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003563 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3564 return true;
3565 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003566 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003567 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003568 break;
3569 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3570 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3571
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003572 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003573 unsigned SrcByte;
3574 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3575 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3576 else
3577 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3578
3579 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3580 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3581 return true;
3582
3583 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3584 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3585 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3586 return true;
3587 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3588 return false;
3589}
3590
3591/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3592/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3593Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerc3eeb422007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003594 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3595 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3596 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003597
3598 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3599 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003600 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattnerc3eeb422007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003601 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003602
3603 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3604 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3605 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3606 return 0;
3607
3608 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3609 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3610 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3611
3612 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3613 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3614 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3615 return 0;
Chris Lattnerc3eeb422007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003616 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy, ITy };
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003617 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattnerc3eeb422007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003618 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 2);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003619 return new CallInst(F, V);
3620}
3621
3622
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003623Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003624 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003625 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003626
Chris Lattner3a8248f2007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003627 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
3628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003629
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003630 // or X, X = X
3631 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003633
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003634 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3635 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner3a8248f2007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003636 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3637 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3638 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3639 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3640 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3641 return &I;
3642 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003643
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003644 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003645 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003646 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003647 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3648 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003649 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003650 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003651 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003652 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3653 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003654 }
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003655
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003656 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3657 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003658 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003659 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003660 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003661 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003662 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003663 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003664
3665 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3666 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003667 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003668 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003669 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3670 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3671 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003672 }
3673
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003674 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3675 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003676
3677 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3678 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3680 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3681 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3683
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003684 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3685 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003686 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003687 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3688 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3689 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003690 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3691 return BSwap;
3692 }
3693
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003694 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3695 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003696 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003697 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3698 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3699 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3700 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003701 }
3702
3703 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3704 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003705 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003706 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3707 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3708 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3709 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003710 }
3711
Chris Lattner1150df92007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003712 // (A & C)|(B & D)
3713 Value *C, *D;
3714 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3715 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner7621a032007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003716 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3717 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3718 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3719 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3720 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3721 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3722 // replace with V+N.
3723 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3724 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3725 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3726 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3727 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3728 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3729 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3730 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3731 }
3732 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3733 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3734 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3735 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3736 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3738 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3739 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3740 }
3741 }
Chris Lattnerc8d37882007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003742 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner7621a032007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003743 }
3744
Chris Lattner1150df92007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003745 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3746 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattner1150df92007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003747 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3748 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3749 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3750 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3751 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3752 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3753 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3754 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3755 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3756
3757 if (V1) {
3758 Value *Or =
3759 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3760 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003761 }
Chris Lattner1150df92007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003762
3763 // (V1 & V3)|(V2 & ~V3) -> ((V1 ^ V2) & V3) ^ V2
Chris Lattnerc8d37882007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003764 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner1150df92007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003765 // Try all combination of terms to find V3 and ~V3.
3766 if (A->hasOneUse() && match(A, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3767 if (V3 == B)
3768 V1 = D, V2 = C;
3769 else if (V3 == D)
3770 V1 = B, V2 = C;
3771 }
3772 if (B->hasOneUse() && match(B, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3773 if (V3 == A)
3774 V1 = C, V2 = D;
3775 else if (V3 == C)
3776 V1 = A, V2 = D;
3777 }
3778 if (C->hasOneUse() && match(C, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3779 if (V3 == B)
3780 V1 = D, V2 = A;
3781 else if (V3 == D)
3782 V1 = B, V2 = A;
3783 }
3784 if (D->hasOneUse() && match(D, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3785 if (V3 == A)
3786 V1 = C, V2 = B;
3787 else if (V3 == C)
3788 V1 = A, V2 = B;
3789 }
3790 if (V1) {
3791 A = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(V1, V2, "tmp"), I);
3792 A = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, V3, "tmp"), I);
3793 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, V2);
3794 }
3795 }
3796 }
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003797 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003798
3799 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003800 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3801 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3802 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003803 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3804 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3805 Instruction *NewOp =
3806 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3807 SI1->getOperand(0),
3808 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003809 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3810 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003811 }
3812 }
Chris Lattner812aab72003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003813
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003814 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3815 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003817 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003818 } else {
3819 A = 0;
3820 }
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003821 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003822 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3823 if (Op0 == B)
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003824 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003825 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003826
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003827 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003828 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3829 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3830 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3831 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3832 }
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003833 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003834
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003835 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3836 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3837 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003838 return R;
3839
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003840 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3841 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003842 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3843 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3844 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3845 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3846 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3847 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3848 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3849 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3850 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003851 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003852 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3853 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3854 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3855 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003856 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003857 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3858 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3859 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3860 }
3861
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003862 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003863 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3864 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003865 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3866 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003867 // equal.
3868 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3869
3870 switch (LHSCC) {
3871 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003872 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003873 switch (RHSCC) {
3874 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003875 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003876 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3877 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3878 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3879 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3880 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003881 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003882 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003883 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003884 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3886 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner5c219462005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003887 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3892 }
3893 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003895 switch (RHSCC) {
3896 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
3899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
3902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
3903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003904 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003905 }
3906 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003907 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003908 switch (RHSCC) {
3909 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003910 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003911 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
3913 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
3914 false, I);
3915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3916 break;
3917 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3918 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3921 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003922 }
3923 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003924 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003925 switch (RHSCC) {
3926 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
3928 break;
3929 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
3930 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
3931 false, I);
3932 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3933 break;
3934 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
3936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3937 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3938 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003939 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003940 break;
3941 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3942 switch (RHSCC) {
3943 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3944 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
3945 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
3946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3947 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3948 break;
3949 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3950 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003952 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3953 break;
3954 }
3955 break;
3956 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3957 switch (RHSCC) {
3958 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3959 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
3960 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
3961 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3962 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3963 break;
3964 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3965 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003966 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003967 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3968 break;
3969 }
3970 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003971 }
3972 }
3973 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003974
3975 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003976 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003977 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003978 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
3979 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003980 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003981 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003982 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3983 I.getType(), TD) &&
3984 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3985 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003986 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3987 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3988 I.getName());
3989 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3990 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3991 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003992 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003993
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003994
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003995 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003996}
3997
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003998// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
3999struct XorSelf {
4000 Value *RHS;
4001 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4002 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4003 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4004 return &Xor;
4005 }
4006};
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004007
4008
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004009Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004010 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004011 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004012
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004013 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4015
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004016 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4017 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
4018 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004020 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004021
4022 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4023 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004024 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4025 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4026 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4027 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4028 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4029 return &I;
4030 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004031
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004032 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004033 // xor (icmp A, B), true = not (icmp A, B) = !icmp A, B
4034 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004035 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && ICI->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004036 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4037 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004038
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004039 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004040 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004041 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4042 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004043 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4044 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004045 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004046 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004047 }
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004048
4049 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y)
4050 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
4051 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4052 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4053 Instruction *NotY =
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004054 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004055 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4056 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4057 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4058 }
4059 }
Chris Lattnerb24acc72007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004060
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004061 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004062 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004063 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004064 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004065 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4066 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4067 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004068 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004069 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner50490d52007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004070 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattnerb24acc72007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004071 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4072 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4073 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattner9d5aace2007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004074
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004075 }
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004076 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4077 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004078 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004079 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4080 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4081 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004082 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004083 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4084 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004085 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004086 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4087 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4088 return &I;
4089 }
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004090 }
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004091 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004092
4093 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4094 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004095 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004096 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004097 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4098 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4099 return NV;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004100 }
4101
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004102 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004103 if (X == Op1)
4104 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004105 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004106
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004107 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004108 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004109 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004110
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004111
4112 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4113 if (Op1I) {
4114 Value *A, *B;
4115 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4116 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004117 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004118 I.swapOperands();
4119 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004120 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004121 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004122 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004123 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004124 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4125 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4126 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4127 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4128 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4129 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner04277992007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004130 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004131 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner04277992007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004132 std::swap(A, B);
4133 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004134 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004135 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4136 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4137 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004138 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004139 }
4140
4141 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4142 if (Op0I) {
4143 Value *A, *B;
4144 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4145 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4146 std::swap(A, B);
4147 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4148 Instruction *NotB =
4149 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4150 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004151 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004152 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4153 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4154 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4155 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4157 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4158 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4159 std::swap(A, B);
4160 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattner6cf49142006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004161 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004162 Instruction *N =
4163 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004164 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4165 }
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004166 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004167 }
4168
4169 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4170 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4171 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4172 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4173 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4174 Instruction *NewOp =
4175 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4176 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4177 Op0I->getName()), I);
4178 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4179 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4180 }
4181
4182 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4183 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4184 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4185 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4186 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4187 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4188 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4189 }
4190 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4191 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4192 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4193 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4194 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4195 }
4196
4197 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4198 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4199 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4200 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4201 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4202 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4203 if (A == C)
4204 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4205 else if (A == D)
4206 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4207 else if (B == C)
4208 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4209 else if (B == D)
4210 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4211
4212 if (X) {
4213 Instruction *NewOp =
4214 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4215 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4216 }
4217 }
4218 }
4219
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004220 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4221 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4222 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004223 return R;
4224
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004225 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004226 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004227 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004228 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4229 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004230 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004231 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004232 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4233 I.getType(), TD) &&
4234 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4235 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004236 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4237 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4238 I.getName());
4239 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4240 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4241 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004242 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004243
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004244 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004245}
4246
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004247/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4248/// overflowed for this type.
4249static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004250 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004251 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004252
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004253 if (IsSigned)
4254 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4255 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4256 else
4257 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4258 else
4259 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004260}
4261
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004262/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4263/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4264/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4265static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4266 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4267 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004268 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4269 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004270
4271 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner77defba2006-02-07 07:00:41 +00004272 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-TD.getPointerSize()*8);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004273
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004274 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4275 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattnerd35d2102005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004276 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004277 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004278 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
4279 if (!OpC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004280 OpC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004281 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4282 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4283 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4284 else {
4285 // Emit an add instruction.
4286 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4287 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4288 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4289 }
4290 }
4291 } else {
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004292 // Convert to correct type.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004293 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::createSExtOrBitCast(Op, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004294 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4295 if (Size != 1)
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004296 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4297 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4298 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004299
4300 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004301 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004302 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4303 }
4304 }
4305 return Result;
4306}
4307
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004308/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004309/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004310Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4311 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4312 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004313 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004314
4315 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4316 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4317 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4318
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004319 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4320 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4321 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004322 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4323 // each index is zero or not.
4324 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004325 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004326 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4327 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004328 bool EmitIt = true;
4329 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4330 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4332 if (C->isNullValue())
4333 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004334 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4335 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004336 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004338 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4339 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004340 }
4341
4342 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004343 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004344 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004345 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4346 if (InVal == 0)
4347 InVal = Comp;
4348 else {
4349 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4350 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004351 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004352 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4353 else // True if all are equal
4354 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4355 }
4356 }
4357 }
4358
4359 if (InVal)
4360 return InVal;
4361 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004362 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004363 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4364 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004365 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004366
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004367 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004368 // the result to fold to a constant!
4369 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4370 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4371 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004372 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4373 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004374 }
4375 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004376 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4377 // compare the base pointer.
4378 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4379 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004380 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattnerbd43b9d2005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004381 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004382 if (IndicesTheSame)
4383 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4384 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4385 IndicesTheSame = false;
4386 break;
4387 }
4388
4389 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4390 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004391 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4392 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004393
4394 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4395 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004396 return 0;
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004397 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004398
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004399 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4400 bool AllZeros = true;
4401 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4402 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4403 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4404 AllZeros = false;
4405 break;
4406 }
4407 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004408 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4409 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004410
4411 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004412 AllZeros = true;
4413 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4414 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4415 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4416 AllZeros = false;
4417 break;
4418 }
4419 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004420 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004421
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004422 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4423 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4424 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4425 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4426 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4427 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004428 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4429 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004430 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004431 NumDifferences = 2;
4432 break;
4433 } else {
4434 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4435 DiffOperand = i;
4436 }
4437 }
4438
4439 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4440 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004441 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4442 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004443 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004444 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4445 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004446 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4447 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004448 }
4449 }
4450
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004451 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004452 // the result to fold to a constant!
4453 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4454 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4455 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4456 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4457 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004458 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004459 }
4460 }
4461 return 0;
4462}
4463
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004464Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4465 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004466 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004467
Chris Lattner6ee923f2007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004468 // Fold trivial predicates.
4469 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4471 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4472 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4473
4474 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4475 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4476 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4477 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4478 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4479 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4480 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4481 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4482 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4483 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4484 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4485 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4486
4487 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4488 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4489 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4490 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4491 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4492 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4493 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4494 return &I;
4495
4496 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4497 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4498 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4499 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4500 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4501 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4502 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4503 return &I;
4504 }
4505 }
4506
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004507 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004508 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004509
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004510 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4511 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4512 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4513 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4514 case Instruction::PHI:
4515 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4516 return NV;
4517 break;
4518 case Instruction::Select:
4519 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4520 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4521 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4522 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4523 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4524 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4525 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4526 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4527 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4528 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4529 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4530 I.getName()), I);
4531 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4532 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4533 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4534 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4535 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4536 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4537 I.getName()), I);
4538 }
4539 }
4540
4541 if (Op1)
4542 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4543 break;
4544 }
4545 }
4546
4547 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4548}
4549
4550Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4551 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4552 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4553 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4554
4555 // icmp X, X
4556 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004557 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4558 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004559
4560 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004562
4563 // icmp of GlobalValues can never equal each other as long as they aren't
4564 // external weak linkage type.
4565 if (GlobalValue *GV0 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op0))
4566 if (GlobalValue *GV1 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op1))
4567 if (!GV0->hasExternalWeakLinkage() || !GV1->hasExternalWeakLinkage())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4569 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004570
4571 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004572 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004573 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4574 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4575 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004576 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4578 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004579
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004580 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004581 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004582 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4583 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4584 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004585 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004586 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004587 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004588 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004589 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004590 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004591
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004592 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4594 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004595 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004596 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4597 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004598 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4599 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4600 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4601 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004602 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4604 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004605 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004606 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4607 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004608 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4609 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4610 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4611 }
4612 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004613 }
4614
Chris Lattner2dd01742004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004615 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4616 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004617 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004618 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4619 default: break;
4620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4621 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004623 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4624 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4625 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4626 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4627 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004628
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4630 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004632 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4633 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4634 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4635 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4636 break;
4637
4638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4639 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004641 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4642 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4643 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4644 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4645 break;
4646
4647 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4648 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004650 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4651 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4652 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4653 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4654 break;
4655
4656 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4657 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004659 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4660 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4661 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4662 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4663 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004664
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4666 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004668 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4669 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4670 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4671 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4672 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004673
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004674 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4675 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004677 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4678 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4679 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4680 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4681 break;
4682
4683 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4684 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004685 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004686 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4687 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4688 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4689 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4690 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004691 }
4692
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004693 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4694 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004695 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4696 //
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004697 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4698 default: break;
4699 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4700 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4701 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4702 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4703 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4704 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4706 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4707 }
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004708
4709 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
4710 // in the input.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004711 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4712 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4713 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004714 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4715 return &I;
4716
4717 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4718 // in.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004719 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004720 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4721 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004722 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4723 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004724 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004725 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4726 Max);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004727 } else {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004728 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4729 Max);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004730 }
4731 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4732 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4733 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004734 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004736 break;
4737 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004738 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004739 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004740 break;
4741 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004742 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004743 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner467b69c2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004744 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004746 break;
4747 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004748 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004749 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner467b69c2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004750 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004752 break;
4753 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004754 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004756 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004758 break;
4759 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004760 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004761 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner467b69c2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004762 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004763 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004764 break;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004765 }
4766 }
4767
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004768 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004769 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004770 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattnere1e10e12004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004771 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004772 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
4773 return Res;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004774 }
4775
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004776 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004777 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4778 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4779 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004780 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4781 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004782 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004783 bool isAllZeros = true;
4784 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4785 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
4786 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4787 isAllZeros = false;
4788 break;
4789 }
4790 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004791 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004792 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
4793 }
4794 break;
4795
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004796 case Instruction::PHI:
4797 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4798 return NV;
4799 break;
Chris Lattner3dbe65f2007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004800 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004801 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4802 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4803 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4804 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4805 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4806 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4807 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004808 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4809 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4810 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4811 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4812 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004813 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4814 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004815 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4816 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4817 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4818 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4819 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004820 }
4821 }
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004822
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004823 if (Op1)
4824 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4825 break;
4826 }
Chris Lattner3dbe65f2007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004827 case Instruction::Malloc:
4828 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
4829 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
4830 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
4831 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
4832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4833 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
4834 }
4835 break;
4836 }
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004837 }
4838
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004839 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004840 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004841 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004842 return NI;
4843 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004844 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
4845 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004846 return NI;
4847
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004848 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004849 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
4850 // now.
4851 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
4852 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
4853 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004854 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
4855 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004856 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004857
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004858 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
4859 // so eliminate it as well.
4860 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
4861 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004862
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004863 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004864 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004865 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004866 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004867 } else {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004868 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00004869 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004870 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004871 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004872 }
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004873 }
4874
4875 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004876 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00004877 // This comes up when you have code like
4878 // int X = A < B;
4879 // if (X) ...
4880 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004881 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
4882 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004883 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004884 return R;
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00004885 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00004886
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004887 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00004888 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4889 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4890 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
4891 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
4892 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
4893 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
4894 }
4895
4896 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4897 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
4898 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
4899 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
4900 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004901 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00004902 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
4903 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
4904 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
4905 }
4906
4907 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
4908 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
4909 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
4910 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
4911 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
4912 }
4913 }
4914
4915 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4916 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00004917 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
4918 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004919 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
4920 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00004921 }
4922 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00004923 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004924 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
4925 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00004926 }
4927 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00004928 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004929 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
4930 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00004931 }
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00004932
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00004933 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
4934 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
4935 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4936 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4937 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4938
4939 if (A == C) {
4940 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
4941 } else if (A == D) {
4942 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
4943 } else if (B == C) {
4944 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
4945 } else if (B == D) {
4946 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
4947 }
4948
4949 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
4950 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
4951 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
4952 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
4953 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
4954 return &I;
4955 }
4956 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00004957 }
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004958 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004959}
4960
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004961/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
4962///
4963Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
4964 Instruction *LHSI,
4965 ConstantInt *RHS) {
4966 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
4967
4968 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sandsf01a47c2007-04-04 06:42:45 +00004969 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004970 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4971 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
4972 // fold the xor.
4973 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
4974 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
4975 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
4976
4977 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
4978 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
4979 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
4980 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
4981 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
4982 return &ICI;
4983 }
4984
4985 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
4986 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
4987
4988 // If so, the new one isn't.
4989 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
4990
4991 if (isTrueIfPositive)
4992 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
4993 else
4994 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
4995 }
4996 }
4997 break;
4998 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
4999 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5000 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5001 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5002
5003 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5004 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5005 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5006 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5007 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5008 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5009 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5010 // bit would not work.
5011 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5012 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5013 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5014 uint32_t BitWidth =
5015 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5016 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5017 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5018 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5019 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5020 Instruction *NewAnd =
5021 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5022 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5023 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5024 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5025 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5026 }
5027 }
5028
5029 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5030 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5031 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5032 // access.
5033 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5034 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5035 Shift = 0;
5036
5037 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5038 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5039 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5040 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5041
5042 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5043 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5044 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5045 if (ShAmt) {
5046 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5047 if (!CanFold) {
5048 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5049 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5050 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5051 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5052
5053 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5054 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5055 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5056 CanFold = true;
5057 }
5058
5059 if (CanFold) {
5060 Constant *NewCst;
5061 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5062 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5063 else
5064 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5065
5066 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5067 // compared.
5068 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5069 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5070 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5071 // result is always true or false now.
5072 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5074 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5075 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5076 } else {
5077 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5078 Constant *NewAndCST;
5079 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5080 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5081 else
5082 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5083 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5084 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5085 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5086 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5087 return &ICI;
5088 }
5089 }
5090 }
5091
5092 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5093 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5094 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5095 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5096 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5097 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5098 // Compute C << Y.
5099 Value *NS;
5100 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5101 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5102 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5103 } else {
5104 // Insert a logical shift.
5105 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5106 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5107 }
5108 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5109
5110 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5111 Instruction *NewAnd =
5112 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5113 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5114
5115 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5116 return &ICI;
5117 }
5118 }
5119 break;
5120
5121 case Instruction::Shl: // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5122 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5123 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5124 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5125
5126 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5127 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5128 // simplified.
5129 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5130 break;
5131
5132 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5133 // comparison cannot succeed.
5134 Constant *Comp =
5135 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5136 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5137 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5138 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5139 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5140 }
5141
5142 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5143 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5144 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5145 Constant *Mask =
5146 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
5147
5148 Instruction *AndI =
5149 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5150 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5151 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5152 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Chris Lattnere5bbb3c2007-04-03 23:29:39 +00005153 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005154 }
5155 }
5156 }
5157 break;
5158
5159 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
5160 case Instruction::AShr:
5161 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5162 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5163 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5164 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5165 // simplified.
5166 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5167 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5168 break;
5169 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5170
5171 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5172 // comparison cannot succeed.
5173 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5174 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5175 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5176 else
5177 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5178
5179 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5180 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5181 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5183 }
5184
5185 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5186 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5187 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5188 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
5189
5190 Instruction *AndI =
5191 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5192 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5193 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5194 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5195 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
5196 }
5197 }
5198 }
5199 break;
5200
5201 case Instruction::SDiv:
5202 case Instruction::UDiv:
5203 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5204 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5205 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5206 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5207 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5208 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
5209 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5210 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5211 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5212 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5213 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5214 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5215 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5216 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5217 // if it finds it.
5218 bool DivIsSigned = LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5219 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5220 break;
5221 if (DivRHS->isZero())
5222 break; // Don't hack on div by zero
5223
5224 // Initialize the variables that will indicate the nature of the
5225 // range check.
5226 bool LoOverflow = false, HiOverflow = false;
5227 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5228
5229 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5230 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5231 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5232 // instead of computing a divide.
5233 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(RHS, DivRHS);
5234
5235 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5236 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5237 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5238 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5239 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != RHS;
5240
5241 // Get the ICmp opcode
5242 ICmpInst::Predicate predicate = ICI.getPredicate();
5243
5244 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
5245 LoBound = Prod;
5246 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5247 HiOverflow = ProdOV ||
5248 AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
5249 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5250 if (RHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
5251 // Can't overflow.
5252 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5253 HiBound = DivRHS;
5254 } else if (RHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
5255 LoBound = Prod;
5256 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5257 HiOverflow = ProdOV ||
5258 AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
5259 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
5260 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5261 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
5262 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true);
5263 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5264 HiOverflow = ProdOV;
5265 }
5266 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5267 if (RHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
5268 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5269 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
5270 if (HiBound == DivRHS)
5271 LoBound = 0; // - INTMIN = INTMIN
5272 } else if (RHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
5273 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5274 if (!LoOverflow)
5275 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS),
5276 true);
5277 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5278 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
5279 LoBound = Prod;
5280 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
5281 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5282 }
5283
5284 // Dividing by a negate swaps the condition.
5285 predicate = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(predicate);
5286 }
5287
5288 if (LoBound) {
5289 Value *X = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5290 switch (predicate) {
5291 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5292 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5293 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5295 else if (HiOverflow)
5296 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5297 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5298 else if (LoOverflow)
5299 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5300 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5301 else
5302 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
5303 true, ICI);
5304 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5305 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5306 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5307 else if (HiOverflow)
5308 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5309 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5310 else if (LoOverflow)
5311 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5312 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5313 else
5314 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
5315 false, ICI);
5316 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5317 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5318 if (LoOverflow)
5319 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5320 return new ICmpInst(predicate, X, LoBound);
5321 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5322 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5323 if (HiOverflow)
5324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5325 if (predicate == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
5326 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5327 else
5328 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5329 }
5330 }
5331 }
5332 break;
5333 }
5334
5335 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5336 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5337 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5338
5339 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5340 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5341 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5342 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5343 case Instruction::SRem:
5344 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5345 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5346 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5347 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5348 Instruction *NewRem =
5349 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5350 BO->getName());
5351 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5352 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5353 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5354 }
5355 }
5356 break;
5357 case Instruction::Add:
5358 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5359 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5360 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5361 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5362 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5363 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5364 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5365 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5366 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5367
5368 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5369 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5370 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5371 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5372 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5373 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5374 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5375 Neg->takeName(BO);
5376 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5377 }
5378 }
5379 break;
5380 case Instruction::Xor:
5381 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5382 // the explicit xor.
5383 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5384 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5385 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5386
5387 // FALLTHROUGH
5388 case Instruction::Sub:
5389 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5390 if (RHSV == 0)
5391 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5392 BO->getOperand(1));
5393 break;
5394
5395 case Instruction::Or:
5396 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5397 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5398 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5399 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5400 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5401 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5402 isICMP_NE));
5403 }
5404 break;
5405
5406 case Instruction::And:
5407 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5408 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5409 // comparison can never succeed!
5410 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5412 isICMP_NE));
5413
5414 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5415 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5416 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5417 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5418 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5419
5420 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5421 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5422 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5423 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5424 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5425 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5426 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5427 }
5428
5429 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5430 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5431 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5432 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5433 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5434 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5435 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5436 }
5437 }
5438 default: break;
5439 }
5440 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5441 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5442 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5443 AddToWorkList(II);
5444 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5445 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5446 return &ICI;
5447 }
5448 }
5449 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
5450 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size, then
5451 // since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
5452 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5453 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5454 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5455 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5456 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5457 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5458 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5459 // smaller constant values.
5460 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5461 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5462 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5463 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5464 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5465 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5466 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5467 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5468 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5469 }
5470 }
5471 }
5472 }
5473 return 0;
5474}
5475
5476/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5477/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5478///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005479Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5480 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005481 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5482 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005483 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005484 Value *RHSCIOp;
5485
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005486 // We only handle extension cast instructions, so far. Enforce this.
5487 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5488 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005489 return 0;
5490
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005491 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5492 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005493
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005494 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005495 // Not an extension from the same type?
5496 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005497 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5498 return 0;
Chris Lattner387bf3f2007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005499
5500 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5501 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5502 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5503 return 0;
5504
5505 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5506 // then we can't handle this.
5507 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5508 return 0;
5509
5510 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5511 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer279fa252004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005512 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005513
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005514 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5515 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5516 if (!CI)
5517 return 0;
5518
5519 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5520 // reextended to DestTy.
5521 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5522 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5523
5524 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5525 if (Res2 == CI) {
5526 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5527 // For example, we might have:
5528 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5529 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5530 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5531 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5532 // because %A may have negative value.
5533 //
5534 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5535 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005536 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005537 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5538 else
5539 return 0;
5540 }
5541
5542 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5543 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5544
5545 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5546 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5547 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005549 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005551
5552 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5553 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5554 Value *Result;
5555 if (isSignedCmp) {
5556 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005557 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005558 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005559 else
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005560 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005561 } else {
5562 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5563 if (isSignedExt) {
5564 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5565 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005566 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005567 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5568 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5569 } else {
5570 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005571 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005572 }
5573 }
5574
5575 // Finally, return the value computed.
5576 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5577 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5579 } else {
5580 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5581 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5582 "ICmp should be folded!");
5583 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5585 else
5586 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5587 }
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005588}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005589
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005590Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5591 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5592}
5593
5594Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5595 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5596}
5597
5598Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5599 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5600}
5601
5602Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5603 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005604 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005605
5606 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5607 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005608 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005609 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005611
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005612 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5613 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner67f05452004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005615 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005616 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5617 }
5618 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005619 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5620 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5621 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005623 }
5624
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005625 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5626 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005627 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005628 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005629 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5630
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005631 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5632 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5633 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005634 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005635 return R;
5636
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005637 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005638 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005639 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5640 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005641 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005642 }
5643 }
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005644
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005645 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005646 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5647 return Res;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005648 return 0;
5649}
5650
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005651Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005652 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005653 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005654
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005655 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5656 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005657 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5658 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5659 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005660 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5661 return &I;
5662
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005663 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5664 // of a signed value.
5665 //
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005666 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005667 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5669 else {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005670 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005671 return &I;
Chris Lattnerf5ce2542004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005672 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005673 }
5674
5675 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5676 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5677 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5678 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5679 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5680 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5681
5682 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5683 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5684 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5685 return R;
5686 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5687 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5688 return NV;
5689
5690 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005691 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5692 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5693 Value *V1, *V2;
5694 ConstantInt *CC;
5695 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005696 default: break;
5697 case Instruction::Add:
5698 case Instruction::And:
5699 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005700 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005701 // These operators commute.
5702 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005703 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5704 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005705 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005706 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005707 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005708 Op0BO->getName());
5709 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005710 Instruction *X =
5711 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5712 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005713 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005714 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng5e60a4a2007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005715 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5716 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005717 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005718
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005719 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005720 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfe53cf22007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005721 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005722 match(Op0BOOp1,
5723 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnerfe53cf22007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005724 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5725 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005726 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005727 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5728 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005729 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5730 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005731 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005732 V1->getName()+".mask");
5733 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5734
5735 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5736 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005737 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005738
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005739 // FALL THROUGH.
5740 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005741 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005742 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5743 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005744 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005745 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005746 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5747 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005748 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005749 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005750 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005751 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005752 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005753 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng5e60a4a2007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005754 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5755 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005756 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005757
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005758 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005759 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5760 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5761 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005762 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005763 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5764 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005765 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005766 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5767 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005768 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5769 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005770 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005771 V1->getName()+".mask");
5772 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5773
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005774 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005775 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005776
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005777 break;
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005778 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005779 }
5780
5781
5782 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
5783 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
5784 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
5785 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
5786 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
5787
5788 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005789 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner44bd3922004-10-08 03:46:20 +00005790 case Instruction::Add:
5791 isValid = isLeftShift;
5792 break;
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005793 case Instruction::Or:
5794 case Instruction::Xor:
5795 highBitSet = false;
5796 break;
5797 case Instruction::And:
5798 highBitSet = true;
5799 break;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005800 }
5801
5802 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
5803 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
5804 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
5805 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
5806 // operation.
5807 //
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005808 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00005809 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005810 }
5811
5812 if (isValid) {
5813 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
5814
5815 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005816 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005817 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005818 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005819
5820 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
5821 NewRHS);
5822 }
5823 }
5824 }
5825 }
5826
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005827 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005828 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5829 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
5830 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005831
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005832 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005833 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005834 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5835 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005836 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
5837 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
5838 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005839
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00005840 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005841 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
5842 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005843
5844 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
5845
5846 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner6c344e52007-02-03 23:28:07 +00005847 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005848 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
5849 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5850 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
5851 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
5852 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
5853 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5854 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
5855 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5856 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
5857 Instruction *Shift =
5858 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5859 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5860
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00005861 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005862 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005863 }
5864
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005865 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
5866 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
5867 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
5868 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
5869 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005870 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005871 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005872 }
5873 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
5874 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng150f3bb2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00005875 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005876 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005877 }
5878 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
5879 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
5880 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
5881 // generators.
5882 const Type *SExtType = 0;
5883 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00005884 case 1 :
5885 case 8 :
5886 case 16 :
5887 case 32 :
5888 case 64 :
5889 case 128:
5890 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
5891 break;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005892 default: break;
5893 }
5894 if (SExtType) {
5895 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
5896 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
5897 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
5898 }
5899 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
5900 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00005901 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005902
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005903 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005904 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5905 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5906 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005907 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005908 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005909 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5910
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005911 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
5912 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005913 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005914
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005915 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005916 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5917 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5918 Instruction *Shift =
5919 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5920 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005921
Reid Spencer769a5a82007-03-26 17:18:58 +00005922 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005923 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005924 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005925
5926 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
5927 } else {
5928 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00005929 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005930
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005931 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005932 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5933 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5934 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
5935 Instruction *Shift =
5936 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
5937 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5938 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5939
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005940 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005941 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005942 }
5943
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005944 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005945 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5946 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5947 Instruction *Shift =
5948 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5949 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5950
Reid Spencer441486c2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00005951 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005952 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005953 }
5954
5955 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005956 }
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005957 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005958 return 0;
5959}
5960
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00005961
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005962/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
5963/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
5964/// X*Scale+Offset.
5965///
5966static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen5a1c7502007-04-04 16:58:57 +00005967 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005968 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005969 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005970 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
5971 Scale = 1;
5972 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005973 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
5974 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005975 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005976 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5977 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
5978 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
5979 Offset = 0;
5980 return I->getOperand(0);
5981 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
5982 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
5983 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
5984 Offset = 0;
5985 return I->getOperand(0);
5986 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
5987 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
5988 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
5989 unsigned SubScale;
5990 Value *SubVal =
5991 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
5992 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
5993 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
5994 Scale = SubScale;
5995 return SubVal;
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005996 }
5997 }
5998 }
5999 }
6000 }
6001
6002 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6003 Scale = 1;
6004 Offset = 0;
6005 return Val;
6006}
6007
6008
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006009/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6010/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
6011Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI,
6012 AllocationInst &AI) {
6013 const PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006014 if (!PTy) return 0; // Not casting the allocation to a pointer type.
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006015
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006016 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6017 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006018
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006019 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6020 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6021 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6022 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6023 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6024
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006025 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006026 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattner51f54572007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006027 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006028 }
6029 }
6030
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006031 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6032 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6033 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6034 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006035
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006036 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6037 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006038 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6039
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006040 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6041 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6042 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6043 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6044
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006045 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
6046 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006047 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006048
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006049 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6050 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen5a1c7502007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006051 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6052 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006053 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6054 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6055
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006056 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6057 // do the xform.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006058 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6059 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006060
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006061 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6062 Value *Amt = 0;
6063 if (Scale == 1) {
6064 Amt = NumElements;
6065 } else {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006066 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006067 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6068 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng9bc8ab12007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006069 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006070 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006071 else if (Scale != 1) {
6072 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6073 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006074 }
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006075 }
6076
Jeff Cohen5a1c7502007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006077 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6078 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006079 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6080 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6081 }
6082
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006083 AllocationInst *New;
6084 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006085 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006086 else
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006087 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006088 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006089 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006090
6091 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6092 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6093 // die soon.
6094 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6095 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006096 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6097 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6098 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006099 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6100 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6101 }
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006102 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6103}
6104
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006105/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006106/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6107/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6108/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6109/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6110///
6111/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6112/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6113static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006114 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006115 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6116 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6117 return true;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006118
6119 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006120 if (!I) return false;
6121
6122 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006123
6124 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006125 case Instruction::Add:
6126 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006127 case Instruction::And:
6128 case Instruction::Or:
6129 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006130 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006131 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
6132 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved) &&
6133 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006134
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006135 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006136 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6137 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6138 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6139 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006140 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6141 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6142 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006143 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty,NumCastsRemoved);
6144 }
6145 break;
6146 case Instruction::LShr:
6147 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6148 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6149 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6150 // already zeros.
6151 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006152 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6153 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6154 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006155 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006156 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6157 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006158 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
6159 }
6160 }
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006161 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006162 case Instruction::Trunc:
6163 case Instruction::ZExt:
6164 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006165 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6166 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6167 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006168 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6169 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6170 // casts first.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00006171 if (isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006172 return true;
6173
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006174 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6175 return true;
6176 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006177 break;
6178 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006179 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6180 break;
6181 }
6182
6183 return false;
6184}
6185
6186/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6187/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6188/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006189Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006190 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006191 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006192 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006193
6194 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6195 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerd0622b62006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006196 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006197 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006198 case Instruction::Add:
6199 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006200 case Instruction::And:
6201 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006202 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006203 case Instruction::AShr:
6204 case Instruction::LShr:
6205 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006206 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006207 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6208 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6209 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006210 break;
6211 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006212 case Instruction::Trunc:
6213 case Instruction::ZExt:
6214 case Instruction::SExt:
6215 case Instruction::BitCast:
6216 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
6217 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because its not new.
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006218 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6219 return I->getOperand(0);
6220
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006221 // Some other kind of cast, which shouldn't happen, so just ..
6222 // FALL THROUGH
6223 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006224 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6225 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6226 break;
6227 }
6228
6229 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6230}
6231
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006232/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6233Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006234 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6235
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006236 // Casting undef to anything results in undef so might as just replace it and
6237 // get rid of the cast.
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006238 if (isa<UndefValue>(Src)) // cast undef -> undef
6239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(CI.getType()));
6240
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006241 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If its eliminable we just
6242 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006243 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006244 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6245 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6246 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6247 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6248 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006249 }
6250 }
Chris Lattner03841652004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006251
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006252 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6253 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
6254 //
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006255 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006256 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
6257 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6258 if (!isa<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i)) ||
6259 !cast<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6260 AllZeroOperands = false;
6261 break;
6262 }
6263 if (AllZeroOperands) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006264 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6265 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6266 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006267 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6268 return &CI;
6269 }
6270 }
Chris Lattnerec45a4c2006-11-21 17:05:13 +00006271
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006272 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
6273 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006274 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006275 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
6276 return V;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006277
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006278 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006279 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6280 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6281 return NV;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006282
6283 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006284 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6285 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6286 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006287
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006288 return 0;
6289}
6290
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006291/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6292/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006293/// cases.
6294/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6295Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6296 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6297 return Result;
6298
6299 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6300 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6301 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006302 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6303 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006304
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006305 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6306 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006307 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6308 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006309 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6310 return &CI;
6311
6312 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6313 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006314 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6315 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006316 return 0;
6317
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006318 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006319 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006320 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6321 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
6322 NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006323 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
6324 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a noop-cast
6325 // this just removes a noop cast which isn't pointful, but simplifies
6326 // the code. If this is a zero-extension, we need to do an AND to
6327 // maintain the clear top-part of the computation, so we require that
6328 // the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this is a sign
6329 // extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
6330 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006331 bool DoXForm;
6332 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6333 default:
6334 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6335 // get here because of the check above.
6336 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6337 case Instruction::Trunc:
6338 DoXForm = true;
6339 break;
6340 case Instruction::ZExt:
6341 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6342 break;
6343 case Instruction::SExt:
6344 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6345 break;
6346 case Instruction::BitCast:
6347 DoXForm = false;
6348 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006349 }
6350
6351 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006352 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6353 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006354 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6355 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6356 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6357 case Instruction::Trunc:
6358 case Instruction::BitCast:
6359 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6361 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6362 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6363 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattner9d5aace2007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006364 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6365 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006366 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6367 }
6368 case Instruction::SExt:
6369 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6370 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006371 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6372 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006373 }
6374 }
6375 }
6376
6377 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6378 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6379
6380 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6381 case Instruction::Add:
6382 case Instruction::Mul:
6383 case Instruction::And:
6384 case Instruction::Or:
6385 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnera74deaf2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006386 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006387 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6388 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6389 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6390 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6391 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006392 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6393 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006394 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006395 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6396 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6397 return BinaryOperator::create(
6398 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006399 }
6400 }
6401
6402 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6403 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6404 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006405 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006406 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006407 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006408 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6409 }
6410 break;
6411 case Instruction::SDiv:
6412 case Instruction::UDiv:
6413 case Instruction::SRem:
6414 case Instruction::URem:
6415 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6416 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6417 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6418 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6419 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006420 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6421 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006422 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6423 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6424 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6425 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006426 return BinaryOperator::create(
6427 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6428 }
6429 }
6430 break;
6431
6432 case Instruction::Shl:
6433 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6434 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6435 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6436 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6437 // in the value.
6438 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6439 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006440 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6441 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6442 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006443 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006444 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006445 }
6446 break;
6447 case Instruction::AShr:
6448 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6449 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6450 // simplifications.
6451 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6452 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006453 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006454 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6455 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006456 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006457 }
6458 }
6459 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006460 }
6461 return 0;
6462}
6463
6464Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006465 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6466 return Result;
6467
6468 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6469 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006470 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6471 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006472
6473 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6474 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6475 default: break;
6476 case Instruction::LShr:
6477 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6478 // are already zeros.
6479 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006480 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006481
6482 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Sheng2777a312007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006483 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006484 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6485 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006486 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6487 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6488
6489 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6490 // shift.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006491 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6492 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6493 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006494 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006495 }
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006496 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6497
6498 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6499 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6500 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006501 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006502 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6503
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006504 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006505 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006506 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006507 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6508 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6509 "tmp"), CI);
6510 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006511 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006512 }
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006513 }
6514 break;
6515 }
6516 }
6517
6518 return 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006519}
6520
6521Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(CastInst &CI) {
6522 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6523 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6524 return Result;
6525
6526 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6527
6528 // If this is a cast of a cast
6529 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006530 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6531 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6532 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6533 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6534 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6535 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006536 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6537 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6538 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006539 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6540 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6541 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Sheng2777a312007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006542 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006543 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006544 Instruction *And =
6545 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6546 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6547 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6548 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6549 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006550 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006551 }
6552 return And;
6553 }
6554 }
6555 }
6556
Chris Lattner7ddbff02007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006557 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6558 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6559 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6560 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6561 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
6562 const APInt& Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
6563 // cast (X == 0) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6564 // cast (X == 0) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6565 // cast (X == 1) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6566 // cast (X == 2) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6567 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6568 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6569 // cast (X != 1) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6570 // cast (X != 2) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6571 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
6572 // This only works for EQ and NE
6573 ICI->isEquality()) {
6574 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6575 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6576 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6577 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
6578 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6579
6580 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
6581 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
6582 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6583 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
6584 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6585 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
6586 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
6587 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
6588 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6589 }
6590
6591 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
6592 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6593 if (ShiftAmt) {
6594 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6595 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6596 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
6597 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
6598 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6599 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
6600 }
6601
6602 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
6603 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6604 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6605 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6606 }
6607
6608 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6609 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6610 else
6611 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
6612 }
6613 }
6614 }
6615 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006616 return 0;
6617}
6618
6619Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(CastInst &CI) {
6620 return commonIntCastTransforms(CI);
6621}
6622
6623Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6624 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6625}
6626
6627Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
6628 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6629}
6630
6631Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006632 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006633}
6634
6635Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006636 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006637}
6638
6639Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6640 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6641}
6642
6643Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6644 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6645}
6646
6647Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006648 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006649}
6650
6651Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
6652 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6653}
6654
6655Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(CastInst &CI) {
6656
6657 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
6658 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
6659 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6660 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6661 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6662
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00006663 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006664 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6665 return Result;
6666 } else {
6667 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6668 return Result;
6669 }
6670
6671
6672 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
6673 // be replaced by the operand.
6674 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
6675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
6676
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006677 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent to
6678 // a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate getelementptr.
6679 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006680 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
6681 if (const PointerType *SrcPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
6682 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
6683 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006684
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006685 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006686 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006687 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
6688 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
6689 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
6690 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006691 ++NumZeros;
6692 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006693
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006694 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006695 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
Chris Lattner416a8932007-01-31 20:08:52 +00006696 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
6697 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, &Idxs[0], Idxs.size());
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006698 }
6699 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006700 }
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00006701
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006702 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
6703 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
6704 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
6705 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00006706 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
6707 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006708 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
6709 CastInst *Tmp;
6710 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
6711 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
6712 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
6713 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
6714 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
6715 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
6716 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006717 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6718 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
6719 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6720 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006721 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
6722 // know the vector types match #elts.
6723 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +00006724 }
6725 }
6726 }
6727 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00006728 return 0;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00006729}
6730
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006731/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
6732/// %C = or %A, %B
6733/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
6734/// into:
6735/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
6736/// %D = or %A, %C
6737///
6738/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
6739/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
6740/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
6741///
6742static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
6743 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6744 case Instruction::Add:
6745 case Instruction::Mul:
6746 case Instruction::And:
6747 case Instruction::Or:
6748 case Instruction::Xor:
6749 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
6750 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
6751 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006752 case Instruction::LShr:
6753 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006754 return 1;
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006755 default:
6756 return 0; // Cannot fold
6757 }
6758}
6759
6760/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
6761/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
6762static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
6763 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6764 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
6765 case Instruction::Add:
6766 case Instruction::Sub:
6767 case Instruction::Or:
6768 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006769 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006770 case Instruction::LShr:
6771 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006772 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006773 case Instruction::And:
6774 return ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
6775 case Instruction::Mul:
6776 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
6777 }
6778}
6779
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006780/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
6781/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
6782Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
6783 Instruction *FI) {
6784 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
6785 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
6786 // merge.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006787 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006788 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
6789 return 0;
6790 } else {
6791 return 0; // unknown unary op.
6792 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006793
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006794 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
6795 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
6796 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
6797 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006798 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
6799 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006800 }
6801
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006802 // Only handle binary operators here.
6803 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006804 return 0;
6805
6806 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
6807 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
6808 bool MatchIsOpZero;
6809 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6810 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6811 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6812 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6813 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6814 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6815 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6816 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6817 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6818 MatchIsOpZero = false;
6819 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
6820 return 0;
6821 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6822 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6823 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6824 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6825 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6826 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6827 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6828 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6829 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6830 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6831 } else {
6832 return 0;
6833 }
6834
6835 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
6836 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
6837 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
6838 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
6839
6840 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
6841 if (MatchIsOpZero)
6842 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
6843 else
6844 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006845 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006846 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
6847 return 0;
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006848}
6849
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00006850Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006851 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
6852 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
6853 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
6854
6855 // select true, X, Y -> X
6856 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006857 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006858 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006859
6860 // select C, X, X -> X
6861 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
6862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6863
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006864 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
6865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6866 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
6867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6868 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
6869 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
6870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6871 else
6872 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6873 }
6874
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006875 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006876 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006877 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006878 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006879 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006880 } else {
6881 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
6882 Value *NotCond =
6883 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6884 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006885 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006886 }
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006887 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006888 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006889 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006890 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006891 } else {
6892 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
6893 Value *NotCond =
6894 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6895 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006896 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006897 }
6898 }
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006899 }
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006900
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006901 // Selecting between two integer constants?
6902 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
6903 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
6904 // select C, 1, 0 -> cast C to int
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006905 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006906 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006907 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006908 // select C, 0, 1 -> cast !C to int
6909 Value *NotCond =
6910 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006911 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006912 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006913 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006914
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006915 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006916
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006917 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
6918 // (x >u 2147483647) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006919 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006920 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
6921 bool CanXForm = false;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006922 if (IC->isSignedPredicate())
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006923 CanXForm = CmpCst->isZero() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006924 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006925 else {
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006926 uint32_t Bits = CmpCst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006927 CanXForm = CmpCst->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Bits) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006928 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006929 }
6930
6931 if (CanXForm) {
6932 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006933 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006934 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006935 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006936 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
6937 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
6938 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006939 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
6940
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006941 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
6942 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
6943 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng56cda952007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006944 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6945 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006946 if (SRASize < SISize)
6947 opc = Instruction::SExt;
6948 else if (SRASize > SISize)
6949 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
6950 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006951 }
6952 }
6953
6954
6955 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006956 // have a fcmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006957 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
6958 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006959 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006960 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006961 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
6962 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
6963 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006964 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
6965 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
6966 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006967 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
6968 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006969 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
6970 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006971 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006972 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006973 Value *V = ICA;
6974 if (ShouldNotVal)
6975 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
6976 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
6977 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
6978 }
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006979 }
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006980 }
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006981
6982 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006983 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6984 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006985 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006986 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006987 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6988 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006989 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6991 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6992
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006993 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006994 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006995 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006997 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006998 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
6999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7000 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7001 }
7002 }
7003
7004 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7005 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7006 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7007 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7008 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7010 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7011 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7013 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7014
7015 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7016 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7017 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7019 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7020 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007021 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007022 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7023 }
7024 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007025
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007026 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7027 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7028 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007029 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7030
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007031 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7032 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7033 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7034 return IV;
7035
7036 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7037 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007038 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7039 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7040 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7041 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7042 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7043 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7044 }
7045
7046 if (AddOp) {
7047 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7048 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7049 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7050 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7051 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7052 }
7053
7054 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007055 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7056 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7057 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7058 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7059 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7060 } else {
7061 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7062 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007063 }
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007064
7065 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7066 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7067 if (AddOp != TI)
7068 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7069 Instruction *NewSel =
7070 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7071
7072 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7073 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007074 }
7075 }
7076 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007077
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007078 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007079 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007080 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7081 // transformation we are doing here.
7082 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7083 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7084 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7085 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7086 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7087 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7088 OpToFold = 1;
7089 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7090 OpToFold = 2;
7091 }
7092
7093 if (OpToFold) {
7094 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007095 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007096 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007097 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007098 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007099 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7100 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007101 else {
7102 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7103 }
7104 }
7105 }
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007106
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007107 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7108 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7109 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7110 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7111 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7112 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7113 OpToFold = 1;
7114 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7115 OpToFold = 2;
7116 }
7117
7118 if (OpToFold) {
7119 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007120 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007121 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007122 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007123 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007124 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7125 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007126 else
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007127 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007128 }
7129 }
7130 }
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007131
7132 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7133 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7134 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7135 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7136 return &SI;
7137 }
7138
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007139 return 0;
7140}
7141
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007142/// GetKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that we can
7143/// determine, return it, otherwise return 0.
7144static unsigned GetKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD) {
7145 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7146 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7147 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007148 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007149 return Align;
7150 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7151 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7152 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7153 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007154 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007155 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7156 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007157 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007158 Align =
7159 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007160 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007161 Align =
7162 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007163 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007164 }
7165 }
7166 return Align;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007167 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007168 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007169 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007170 User *CI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007171 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
7172 return GetKnownAlignment(CI->getOperand(0), TD);
7173 return 0;
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007174 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V) ||
7175 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
7176 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode()==Instruction::GetElementPtr)) {
7177 User *GEPI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007178 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD);
7179 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7180
7181 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7182 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7183 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7184 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7185 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7186 AllZeroOperands = false;
7187 break;
7188 }
7189 if (AllZeroOperands)
7190 return BaseAlignment;
7191
7192 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7193 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7194 // least as much as its type requires.
7195 if (!TD) return 0;
7196
7197 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007198 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007199 if (TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType())
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007200 <= BaseAlignment) {
7201 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007202 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007203 return TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007204 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007205 return 0;
7206 }
7207 return 0;
7208}
7209
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007210
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007211/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7212/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7213/// the heavy lifting.
7214///
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007215Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007216 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7217 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7218
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007219 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7220 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007221 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007222 bool Changed = false;
7223
7224 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7225 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7226 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7227
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007228 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007229 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007230 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7231 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7232 // alignment is sufficient.
7233 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007234 }
7235
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007236 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7237 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7238 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007239 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007240 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7241 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7242 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007243 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth0ebb0b02006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007244 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007245 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007246 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7247 else
7248 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007249 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007250 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7251 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7252 Changed = true;
7253 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007254 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007255
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007256 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7257 // set, update the alignment.
7258 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
7259 unsigned Alignment1 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7260 unsigned Alignment2 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
7261 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007262 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007263 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007264 Changed = true;
7265 }
7266 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
7267 unsigned Alignment = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007268 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007269 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007270 Changed = true;
7271 }
7272 }
7273
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007274 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007275 } else {
7276 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7277 default: break;
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007278 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7279 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007280 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7281 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7282 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7283 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7284 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007285 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007286 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007287 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007288 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7289 }
7290 break;
7291 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7292 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7293 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7294 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007295 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007296 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7297 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007298 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7299 }
7300 break;
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007301 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7302 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7303 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7304 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7305 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7306 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
7307 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007308 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7309 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007310 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7311 }
7312 break;
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007313
7314 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7315 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7316 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7317 uint64_t UndefElts;
7318 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7319 UndefElts)) {
7320 II->setOperand(1, V);
7321 return II;
7322 }
7323 break;
7324 }
7325
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007326 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7327 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007328 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007329 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7330
7331 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7332 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7333 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7334 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7335 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7336 AllEltsOk = false;
7337 break;
7338 }
7339 }
7340
7341 if (AllEltsOk) {
7342 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007343 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7344 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7345 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7346 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007347 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7348
7349 // Only extract each element once.
7350 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7351 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7352
7353 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7354 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7355 continue;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007356 unsigned Idx =cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007357 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7358
7359 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7360 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007361 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007362 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7363 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7364 }
7365
7366 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007367 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007368 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7369 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007370 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007371 }
7372 }
7373 break;
7374
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007375 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7376 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7377 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7378 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7379 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7380 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7381 if (&*++BI == II)
7382 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7383 }
7384 }
7385
7386 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7387 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7388 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7389 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7390 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7391 bool CannotRemove = false;
7392 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7393 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7394 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7395 CannotRemove = true;
7396 break;
7397 }
7398 }
7399 if (!CannotRemove)
7400 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7401 }
7402 break;
7403 }
7404 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007405 }
7406
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007407 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007408}
7409
7410// InvokeInst simplification
7411//
7412Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007413 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007414}
7415
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007416// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7417//
7418Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007419 bool Changed = false;
7420
7421 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7422 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007423 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7424
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007425 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007426
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007427 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7428 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7429 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7430 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7431 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007432 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007433 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007434 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7435 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7436 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7437 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7438 return 0;
7439 }
7440
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007441 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7442 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7443 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7444 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007445 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007446 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007447 CS.getInstruction());
7448
7449 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7450 CS.getInstruction()->
7451 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7452
7453 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7454 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7455 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007456 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007457 }
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007458 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7459 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007460
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007461 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7462 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7463 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7464 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7465 // the call.
7466 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7467 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7468 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7469 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7470 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7471 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007472 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007473 *I = Op;
7474 Changed = true;
7475 }
7476 }
7477 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007478
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007479 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007480}
7481
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007482// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7483// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7484//
7485bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7486 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7487 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007488 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7489 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007490 return false;
Reid Spencer87436872004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007491 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007492 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7493
7494 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7495 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7496 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7497 //
7498 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7499 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7500
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007501 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7502 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007503 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007504 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7505 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7506 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007507 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007508
7509 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7510 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7511 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7512 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7513 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7514 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7515 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7516 UI != E; ++UI)
7517 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7518 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007519 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007520 return false;
7521 }
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007522
7523 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7524 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007525
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007526 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7527 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7528 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007529 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007530 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen7c2001d2007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007531 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007532 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007533 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007534 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007535 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007536 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7537 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00007538 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007539 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen7c2001d2007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007540
7541 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
7542 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
7543 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
7544 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
7545 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
7546 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
7547 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7548 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7549 return false;
7550 }
7551 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
7552 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7553 return false;
7554 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
7555 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7556 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7557 return false;
7558 }
7559 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
7560 return false;
7561 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
7562 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7563 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
7564 return false;
7565 }
7566 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7567 return false;
7568 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
7569 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7570 return false;
7571 } else {
7572 return false;
7573 }
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007574 }
7575
7576 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007577 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007578 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7579
7580 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7581 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7582 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7583 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7584
7585 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7586 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7587 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7588 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7589 Args.push_back(*AI);
7590 } else {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007591 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007592 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007593 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007594 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007595 }
7596 }
7597
7598 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
7599 // now...
7600 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
7601 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
7602
7603 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
7604 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
7605 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlingf3baad32006-12-07 01:30:32 +00007606 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
7607 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007608 } else {
7609 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
7610 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7611 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
7612 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
7613 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007614 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
7615 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007616 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007617 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
7618 Args.push_back(Cast);
7619 } else {
7620 Args.push_back(*AI);
7621 }
7622 }
7623 }
7624
7625 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007626 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007627
7628 Instruction *NC;
7629 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007630 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattnera06a8fd2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007631 &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007632 cast<InvokeInst>(II)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007633 } else {
Chris Lattnera06a8fd2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007634 NC = new CallInst(Callee, &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner6aacb0f2005-05-06 06:48:21 +00007635 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
7636 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007637 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007638 }
7639
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007640 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007641 Value *NV = NC;
7642 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
7643 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007644 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007645 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
7646 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007647 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner686767f2003-10-30 00:46:41 +00007648
7649 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
7650 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
7651 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
7652 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
7653 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
7654 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
7655 } else {
7656 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
7657 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
7658 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007659 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007660 } else {
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00007661 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007662 }
7663 }
7664
7665 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
7666 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner51f54572007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007667 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00007668 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007669 return true;
7670}
7671
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007672/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
7673/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
7674/// and a single binop.
7675Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7676 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007677 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
7678 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007679 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007680 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7681 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
7682
7683 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
7684 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007685
7686 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
7687 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007688 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007689 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007690 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007691 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007692 // types or GEP's with different index types.
7693 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
7694 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007695 return 0;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007696
7697 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
7698 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
7699 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
7700 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
7701 return 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007702
7703 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
7704 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
7705 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007706 }
7707
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007708 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
7709
7710 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
7711 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
7712 // hide them behind a phi.
7713 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
7714 return 0;
7715
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007716 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007717 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007718 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007719 if (LHSVal == 0) {
7720 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
7721 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7722 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007723 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
7724 LHSVal = NewLHS;
7725 }
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007726
7727 if (RHSVal == 0) {
7728 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
7729 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7730 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007731 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
7732 RHSVal = NewRHS;
7733 }
7734
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007735 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
7736 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7737 if (NewLHS) {
7738 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7739 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7740 }
7741 if (NewRHS) {
7742 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
7743 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7744 }
7745 }
7746
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007747 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007748 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007749 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7750 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
7751 RHSVal);
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007752 else {
7753 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
7754 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
7755 }
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007756}
7757
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007758/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
7759/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
7760/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
7761/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007762///
7763/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
7764/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
7765/// to a register.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007766static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
7767 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
7768
7769 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
7770 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
7771 return false;
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007772
7773 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
7774 // profitable to do this xform.
7775 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
7776 bool isAddressTaken = false;
7777 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
7778 UI != E; ++UI) {
7779 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
7780 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
7781 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
7782 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
7783 }
7784 isAddressTaken = true;
7785 break;
7786 }
7787
7788 if (!isAddressTaken)
7789 return false;
7790 }
7791
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007792 return true;
7793}
7794
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007795
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007796// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
7797// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
7798// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
7799Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7800 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
7801
7802 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
7803 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
7804 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
7805 // code size and simplifying code.
7806 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
7807 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007808 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007809 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
7810 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007811 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007812 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
7813 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007814 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007815 if (ConstantOp == 0)
7816 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007817 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
7818 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
7819 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
7820 // load and the PHI.
7821 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
7822 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7823 return 0;
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007824 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007825 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007826 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
7827 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
7828 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007829 } else {
7830 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
7831 }
7832
7833 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
7834 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7835 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
7836 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007837 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007838 return 0;
7839 if (CastSrcTy) {
7840 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
7841 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007842 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007843 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
7844 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007845 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
7846 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
7847 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7848 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007849 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
7850 return 0;
7851 }
7852 }
7853
7854 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
7855 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
7856 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
7857 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00007858 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007859
7860 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7861 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007862
7863 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007864 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7865 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7866 if (NewInVal != InVal)
7867 InVal = 0;
7868 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7869 }
7870
7871 Value *PhiVal;
7872 if (InVal) {
7873 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
7874 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
7875 PhiVal = InVal;
7876 delete NewPN;
7877 } else {
7878 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
7879 PhiVal = NewPN;
7880 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007881
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007882 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007883 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
7884 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00007885 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007886 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007887 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007888 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007889 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7890 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
7891 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007892 else
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007893 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenb622c112007-03-05 00:00:42 +00007894 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007895}
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007896
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007897/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
7898/// that is dead.
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007899static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
7900 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007901 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
7902 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
7903
7904 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007905 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007906 return true;
7907
7908 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
7909 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007910
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007911 return false;
7912}
7913
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007914// PHINode simplification
7915//
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007916Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonbbf89902006-07-10 22:15:25 +00007917 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +00007918 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +00007919
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007920 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
7921 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
7922
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007923 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
7924 // reducing code size.
7925 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
7926 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
7927 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
7928 return Result;
7929
7930 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
7931 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
7932 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007933 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
7934 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
7935 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007936 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007937 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
7938 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
7939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7940 }
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007941
7942 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
7943 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
7944 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
7945 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
7946 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
7947 // late.
7948 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
7949 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
7950 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
7951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7952 }
7953 }
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007954
Chris Lattner91daeb52003-12-19 05:58:40 +00007955 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007956}
7957
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007958static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
7959 Instruction *InsertPoint,
7960 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007961 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7962 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007963 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
7964 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
7965 // used for address computation.
7966 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
7967 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
7968 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
7969 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007970}
7971
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007972
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007973Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007974 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner471bd762003-05-22 19:07:21 +00007975 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, long 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007976 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007977 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007978 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007979
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007980 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
7981 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
7982
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007983 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
7984 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
7985 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
7986
7987 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007989
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007990 // Keep track of whether all indices are zero constants integers.
7991 bool AllZeroIndices = true;
7992
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007993 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
7994 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007995
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007996 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007997 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
7998 // Track whether this GEP has all zero indices, if so, it doesn't move the
7999 // input pointer, it just changes its type.
8000 if (AllZeroIndices) {
8001 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(i)))
8002 AllZeroIndices = CI->isNullValue();
8003 else
8004 AllZeroIndices = false;
8005 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008006 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8007 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008008 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8009 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8010 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8011 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8012 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8013 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8014 MadeChange = true;
8015 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008016 }
8017 }
8018 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008019 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8020 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8021 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8022 // obvious.
8023 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008024 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008025 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008026 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008027 MadeChange = true;
8028 } else {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008029 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8030 GEP);
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008031 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8032 MadeChange = true;
8033 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008034 }
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008035 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008036 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8037
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008038 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8039 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8040 // real input to the dest type.
8041 if (AllZeroIndices && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8042 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
8043 GEP.getType());
8044
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008045 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8046 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8047 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8048 //
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008049 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008050 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008051 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008052
8053 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008054 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8055 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8056 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8057 //
8058 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8059 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8060 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8061
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008062 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008063
8064 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8065 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8066 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8067 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattner8ec5f882004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008068 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008069
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008070 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008071 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattner235af562003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008072 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8073 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8074 //
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008075 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008076 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8077 Sum = GO1;
8078 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8079 Sum = SO1;
8080 } else {
8081 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8082 // target's pointer size.
8083 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8084 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008085 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008086 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008087 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008088 } else {
8089 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008090 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008091 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008092 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008093
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008094 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008095 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008096 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008097 } else {
8098 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008099 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8100 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008101 }
8102 }
8103 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008104 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8105 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8106 else {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008107 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8108 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008109 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008110 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008111
8112 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8113 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8114 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8115 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8116 return &GEP;
8117 } else {
8118 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8119 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8120 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8121 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8122 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008123 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008124 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008125 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008126 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008127 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8128 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008129 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8130 }
8131
8132 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattnera7315132007-02-12 22:56:41 +00008133 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], &Indices[0],
8134 Indices.size(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008135
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008136 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008137 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8138 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8139
8140 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008141 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008142 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8143 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8144 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8145
8146 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008147 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8148 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008149
8150 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8152 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008153 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008154 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8155 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8156 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8157 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8158 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8159 //
8160 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8161 //
8162 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8163 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8164 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8165 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8166 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8167 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8168 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8169 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8170 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8171 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8172 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8173 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8174 return &GEP;
8175 }
8176 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8177 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008178 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8179 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008180 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8181 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8182 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8183 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8184 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
8185 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008186 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008187 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008188 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8189 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008190 }
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008191
8192 // Transform things like:
8193 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8194 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8195 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8196
8197 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008198 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008199 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8200 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8201
8202 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8203 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8204 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8205 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8206 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8207 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8208 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8209 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnera393e4d2005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008210 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008211 Scale = CI;
8212 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8213 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8214 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008215 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8216 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8217 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008218 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8219 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8220 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8221 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8222 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8223 }
8224 }
8225
8226 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8227 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008228 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008229 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008230 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8231 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8232 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008233 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8234 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008235 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8236 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8237 }
8238
8239 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008240 Instruction *NewGEP =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008241 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008242 NewIdx, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008243 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8244 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8245 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008246 }
8247 }
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008248 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008249 }
8250
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008251 return 0;
8252}
8253
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008254Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8255 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8256 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008257 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8258 const Type *NewTy =
8259 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008260 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008261
8262 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8263 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008264 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008265 else {
8266 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008267 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008268 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008269
8270 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008271
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008272 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8273 // allocas if possible...
8274 //
8275 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8276 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8277
8278 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8279 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8280 //
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008281 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008282 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
8283 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008284
8285 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8286 // allocation.
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008287 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008288 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8289 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008290 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008291
8292 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8293 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8294 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008295 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattner49df6ce2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008296 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8298
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008299 return 0;
8300}
8301
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008302Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8303 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8304
8305 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8306 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op))
8307 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
8308 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8309 return &FI;
8310 }
8311
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008312 // free undef -> unreachable.
8313 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8314 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008315 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008316 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008317 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8318 }
8319
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008320 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8321 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008322 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008323 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008324
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008325 return 0;
8326}
8327
8328
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008329/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008330static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8331 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008332 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008333
8334 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008335 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008336 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008337
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008338 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008339 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008340 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8341 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8342 // constants.
8343 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8344 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8345 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008346 Value *Idxs[2];
8347 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8348 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008349 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8350 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8351 }
8352
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008353 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008354 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerecfa9b52005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008355 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8356 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8357 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008358 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8359 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008360
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008361 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8362 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8363 // the result of the loaded value.
8364 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8365 CI->getName(),
8366 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8367 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008368 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008369 }
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008370 }
8371 }
8372 return 0;
8373}
8374
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008375/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008376/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8377/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8378/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8379static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8380 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8381 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8382
8383 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8384 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008385 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8386 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8387 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008388 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8389
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008390 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008391 --BBI;
8392
8393 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8394 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8395 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8396 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008397
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008398 }
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008399 return false;
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008400}
8401
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008402Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8403 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7e8af382004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008404
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008405 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008406 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008407 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8408 return Res;
8409
8410 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8411 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008412
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008413 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8414 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008415 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8416 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008417 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8418 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8419 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008420 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8421 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8422 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008423 }
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008424
8425 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
8426 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0)) ||
8427 isa<UndefValue>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
8428 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8429 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8430 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8431 // CFG.
8432 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8433 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8434 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8435 }
8436
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008437 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008438 // load null/undef -> undef
8439 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008440 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
8441 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
8442 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008443 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8444 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008445 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008446 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008447
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008448 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
8449 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008450 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008452
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008453 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
8454 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
8455 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
8456 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008457 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner0b011ec2005-09-26 05:28:06 +00008458 if (Constant *V =
8459 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008460 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008461 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
8462 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8463 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8464 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8465 // CFG.
8466 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8467 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8469 }
8470
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008471 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008472 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8473 return Res;
8474 }
8475 }
Chris Lattnere228ee52004-04-08 20:39:49 +00008476
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008477 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008478 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
8479 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
8480 // exposes redundancy in the code.
8481 //
8482 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
8483 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
8484 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
8485 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
8486 // unconditionally.
8487 //
8488 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
8489 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008490 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
8491 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008492 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008493 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008494 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008495 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008496 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
8497 }
8498
Chris Lattnerbdcf41a2004-09-23 15:46:00 +00008499 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
8500 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
8501 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8502 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
8503 return &LI;
8504 }
8505
8506 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
8507 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
8508 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8509 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
8510 return &LI;
8511 }
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008512 }
8513 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008514 return 0;
8515}
8516
Reid Spencere928a152007-01-19 21:20:31 +00008517/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008518/// when possible.
8519static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
8520 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
8521 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
8522
8523 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8524 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
8525 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8526
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008527 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008528 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8529 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8530 // constants.
8531 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8532 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8533 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008534 Value* Idxs[2];
8535 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8536 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008537 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8538 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8539 }
8540
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008541 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
8542 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8543 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008544
8545 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008546 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
8547 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008548 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008549 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008550 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
8551 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
8552 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
8553 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
8554 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008555 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008556 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008557 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008558 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
8559 }
8560 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008561 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008562 else
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008563 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008564 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
8565 SI);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008566 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
8567 }
8568 }
8569 }
8570 return 0;
8571}
8572
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008573Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
8574 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
8575 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
8576
8577 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008578 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008579 ++NumCombined;
8580 return 0;
8581 }
Chris Lattnera4beeef2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00008582
8583 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
8584 // alloca dead.
8585 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
8586 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
8587 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8588 ++NumCombined;
8589 return 0;
8590 }
8591
8592 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
8593 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
8594 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8595 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8596 ++NumCombined;
8597 return 0;
8598 }
8599 }
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008600
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008601 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
8602 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
8603 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
8604 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
8605 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
8606 --ScanInsts) {
8607 --BBI;
8608
8609 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
8610 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
8611 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8612 ++NumDeadStore;
8613 ++BBI;
8614 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
8615 continue;
8616 }
8617 break;
8618 }
8619
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008620 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
8621 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
8622 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
8623 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8624 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr) {
8625 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8626 ++NumCombined;
8627 return 0;
8628 }
8629 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
8630 // may not be dead.
8631 break;
8632 }
8633
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008634 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008635 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008636 break;
8637 }
8638
8639
8640 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008641
8642 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
8643 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
8644 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
8645 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
8646 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008647 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008648 ++NumCombined;
8649 }
8650 return 0; // Do not modify these!
8651 }
8652
8653 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
8654 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008655 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008656 ++NumCombined;
8657 return 0;
8658 }
8659
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008660 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
8661 // source instead.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008662 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008663 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8664 return Res;
8665 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008666 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008667 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8668 return Res;
8669
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008670
8671 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
8672 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008673 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008674 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
8675 if (BI->isUnconditional()) {
8676 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
8677 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
8678 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
8679 BasicBlock *Dest = BI->getSuccessor(0);
8680
8681 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(Dest);
8682 BasicBlock *Other = 0;
8683 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8684 Other = *PI;
8685 ++PI;
8686 if (PI != pred_end(Dest)) {
8687 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8688 if (Other)
8689 Other = 0;
8690 else
8691 Other = *PI;
8692 if (++PI != pred_end(Dest))
8693 Other = 0;
8694 }
8695 if (Other) { // If only one other pred...
8696 BBI = Other->getTerminator();
8697 // Make sure this other block ends in an unconditional branch and that
8698 // there is an instruction before the branch.
8699 if (isa<BranchInst>(BBI) && cast<BranchInst>(BBI)->isUnconditional() &&
8700 BBI != Other->begin()) {
8701 --BBI;
8702 StoreInst *OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
8703
8704 // If this instruction is a store to the same location.
8705 if (OtherStore && OtherStore->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8706 // Okay, we know we can perform this transformation. Insert a PHI
8707 // node now if we need it.
8708 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
8709 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
8710 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
8711 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
8712 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
8713 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), Other);
8714 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, Dest->front());
8715 }
8716
8717 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
8718 // insert it.
8719 BBI = Dest->begin();
8720 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
8721 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
8722 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
8723
8724 // Nuke the old stores.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008725 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8726 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008727 ++NumCombined;
8728 return 0;
8729 }
8730 }
8731 }
8732 }
8733
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008734 return 0;
8735}
8736
8737
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008738Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
8739 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00008740 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008741 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
8742 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
8743 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
8744 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
8745 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8746 BI.setCondition(X);
8747 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8748 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
8749 return &BI;
8750 }
8751
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008752 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
8753 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
8754 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8755 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8756 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
8757 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8758 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008759 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008760 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
8761 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008762 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8763 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
8764 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8765 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008766 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008767 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008768 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008769 return &BI;
8770 }
8771
8772 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
8773 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
8774 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8775 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8776 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
8777 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
8778 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8779 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008780 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008781 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
8782 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008783 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008784 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008785 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8786 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008787 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008788 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008789 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008790 return &BI;
8791 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008792
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008793 return 0;
8794}
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008795
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008796Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
8797 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
8798 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
8799 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
8800 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
8801 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
8802 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008803 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008804 AddRHS));
8805 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008806 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008807 return &SI;
8808 }
8809 }
8810 return 0;
8811}
8812
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008813/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
8814/// is to leave as a vector operation.
8815static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
8816 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8817 return true;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008818 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008819 if (isConstant) return true;
8820 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
8821 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
8822 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
8823 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
8824 return false;
8825 return true;
8826 }
8827 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
8828 if (!I) return false;
8829
8830 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
8831 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
8832 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
8833 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
8834 return true;
8835 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
8836 return true;
8837 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
8838 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
8839 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8840 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8841 return true;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008842 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8843 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
8844 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8845 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8846 return true;
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008847
8848 return false;
8849}
8850
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00008851/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
8852///
8853/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
8854/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008855static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
8856 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8857 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8858 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
8859 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8860 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
8861
8862 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008863 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008864 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
8865 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
8866 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
8867 else
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008868 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008869 return Result;
8870}
8871
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008872/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
8873/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
8874/// extracted from the vector.
8875static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008876 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
8877 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008878 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
8879 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008880 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8881
8882 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
8883 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8884 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8885 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008886 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008887 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
8888 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8889 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008890 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
8891 return 0;
8892 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008893
8894 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
8895 // inserted value.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008896 if (EltNo == IIElt)
8897 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008898
8899 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
8900 // vector input.
8901 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008902 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008903 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
8904 if (InEl < Width)
8905 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
8906 else if (InEl < Width*2)
8907 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
8908 else
8909 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008910 }
8911
8912 // Otherwise, we don't know.
8913 return 0;
8914}
8915
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008916Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008917
Chris Lattner92346c32006-03-31 18:25:14 +00008918 // If packed val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
8919 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
8921
8922 // If packed val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
8923 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
8925
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008926 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008927 // If packed val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
8928 // with that operand
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008929 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008930 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008931 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
8932 op0 = 0;
8933 break;
8934 }
8935 if (op0)
8936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008937 }
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008938
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008939 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
8940 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008941 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnera87c9f62007-04-09 01:37:55 +00008942 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
8943 unsigned VectorWidth =
8944 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
8945
8946 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
8947 // crashing the code below.
8948 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
8949 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
8950
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008951 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
8952 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
8953 // property.
Chris Lattnera87c9f62007-04-09 01:37:55 +00008954 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008955 uint64_t UndefElts;
8956 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008957 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008958 UndefElts)) {
8959 EI.setOperand(0, V);
8960 return &EI;
8961 }
8962 }
8963
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008964 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008966 }
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008967
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008968 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008969 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
8970 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
8971 // profitable to do so
8972 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008973 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
8974 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
8975 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
8976 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
8977 EI.getName()+".lhs");
8978 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
8979 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
8980 EI.getName()+".rhs");
8981 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
8982 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
8983 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
8984 }
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008985 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008986 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008987 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
8988 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencera736fdf2006-11-29 01:11:01 +00008989 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008990 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
8991 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008992 }
8993 }
8994 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
8995 // Extracting the inserted element?
8996 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
8997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
8998 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
8999 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9000 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9001 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9002 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9003 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
9004 return &EI;
9005 }
9006 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
9007 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
9008 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009009 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9010 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009011 Value *Src;
9012 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
9013 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
9014 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
9015 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9016 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
9017 } else {
9018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner612fa8e2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00009019 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009020 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009021 }
9022 }
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009023 }
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009024 return 0;
9025}
9026
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009027/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
9028/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
9029/// Otherwise, return false.
9030static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
9031 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
9032 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
9033 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009034 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009035
9036 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009037 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009038 return true;
9039 } else if (V == LHS) {
9040 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009041 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009042 return true;
9043 } else if (V == RHS) {
9044 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009045 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009046 return true;
9047 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9048 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9049 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9050 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9051 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9052
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009053 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
9054 return false;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009055 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009056
9057 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
9058 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9059 // transitively ok.
9060 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9061 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009062 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009063 return true;
9064 }
9065 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
9066 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009067 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9068 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009069 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009070
9071 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
9072 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
9073 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9074 // transitively ok.
9075 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9076 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
9077 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
9078 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009079 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009080 } else {
9081 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
9082 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009083 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009084
9085 }
9086 return true;
9087 }
9088 }
9089 }
9090 }
9091 }
9092 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
9093
9094 return false;
9095}
9096
9097/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9098/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9099/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009100static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009101 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009102 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009103 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009104 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009105 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009106
9107 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009108 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009109 return V;
9110 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009111 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009112 return V;
9113 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9114 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9115 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9116 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9117 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9118
9119 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9120 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9121 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9122 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009123 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9124 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009125
9126 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9127 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009128 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9129 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9130 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009131 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009132 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009133 return V;
9134 }
9135
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009136 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9137 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009138 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9139 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9140 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009141 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009142 }
9143 return V;
9144 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009145
9146 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9147 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9148 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9149 return EI->getOperand(0);
9150
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009151 }
9152 }
9153 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009154 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009155
9156 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9157 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009158 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009159 return V;
9160}
9161
9162Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9163 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9164 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9165 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9166
Chris Lattner4ca9cbb2007-04-09 01:11:16 +00009167 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
9168 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
9169 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9170
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009171 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9172 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9173 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9174 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9175 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9176 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009177 unsigned ExtractedIdx=cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9178 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009179
9180 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9182
9183 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9185
9186 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9187 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9188 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9189 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9190
9191 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9192 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9193 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9194 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9195 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9196 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9197 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9198 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9199 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9200 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009201 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009202 else {
9203 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009204 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009205 NumVectorElts));
9206 }
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009207 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009208 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009209 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009210 }
9211
9212 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9213 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9214 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9215 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009216 Value *RHS = 0;
9217 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9218 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9219 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009220 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009221 }
9222 }
9223 }
9224
9225 return 0;
9226}
9227
9228
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009229Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9230 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9231 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009232 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009233
9234 bool MadeChange = false;
9235
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009236 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009237 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009238 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9239
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009240 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009241 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009242 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9243 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9244 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9245 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9246 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9247 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9248 MadeChange = true;
9249 }
9250 }
9251
9252 if (MadeChange) {
9253 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9254 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9255 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9256 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9257 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9258 else
9259 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9260 }
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009261 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009262 }
9263 }
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009264
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009265 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9266 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9267 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9268 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009269 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9271 }
9272
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009273 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9274 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9275 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009276 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009277 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009278 else {
9279 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9280 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9281 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9282 else
9283 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009284 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009285 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009286 }
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009287 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009288 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009289 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009290 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9291 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009292 MadeChange = true;
9293 }
9294
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009295 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009296 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009297
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009298 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9299 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9300 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9301 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9302
9303 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9304 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009305 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009306
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009307 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9308 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9309 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009310
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009311 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9312 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9313 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9314 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9315 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9316 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9317 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9318 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9319 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9320 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9321 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9322 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9323
9324 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9325 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9326 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9327 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9328 else
9329 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9330
9331 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9332 // the replacement.
9333 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9334 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9335 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9336 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009337 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009338 } else {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009339 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009340 }
9341 }
9342 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9343 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009344 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009345 }
9346 }
9347 }
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009348
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009349 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9350}
9351
9352
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009353
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009354
9355/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9356/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9357/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9358/// end of its block.
9359static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
9360 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
9361
Chris Lattnerc4f67e62005-10-27 17:13:11 +00009362 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
9363 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009364
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009365 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmandcb291f2007-03-22 16:38:57 +00009366 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
9367 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009368 return false;
9369
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009370 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
9371 // the end of block that could change the value.
9372 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009373 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
9374 Scan != E; ++Scan)
9375 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
9376 return false;
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009377 }
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009378
9379 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
9380 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
9381
Chris Lattner9f269e42005-08-08 19:11:57 +00009382 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009383 ++NumSunkInst;
9384 return true;
9385}
9386
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009387
9388/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
9389/// all reachable code to the worklist.
9390///
9391/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
9392/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
9393/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
9394/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
9395/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
9396///
9397static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009398 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009399 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009400 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009401 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
9402 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009403
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009404 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9405 BB = Worklist.back();
9406 Worklist.pop_back();
9407
9408 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
9409 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
9410
9411 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
9412 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009413
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009414 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
9415 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
9416 ++NumDeadInst;
9417 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
9418 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9419 continue;
9420 }
9421
9422 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
9423 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
9424 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
9425 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
9426 ++NumConstProp;
9427 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9428 continue;
9429 }
9430
9431 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009432 }
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009433
9434 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
9435 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
9436 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
9437 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
9438 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
9439 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
9440 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
9441 continue;
9442 }
9443 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
9444 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
9445 // See if this is an explicit destination.
9446 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9447 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
9448 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
9449 continue;
9450 }
9451
9452 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
9453 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
9454 continue;
9455 }
9456 }
9457
9458 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9459 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009460 }
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009461}
9462
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009463bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009464 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00009465 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009466
9467 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
9468 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009469
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009470 {
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009471 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
9472 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
9473 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009474 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009475 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00009476
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009477 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
9478 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
9479 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
9480 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
9481 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
9482 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
9483 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
9484 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner2d3a7a62004-04-27 15:13:33 +00009485
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009486 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009487 ++NumDeadInst;
9488
9489 if (!I->use_empty())
9490 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
9491 I->eraseFromParent();
9492 }
9493 }
9494 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009495
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009496 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9497 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
9498 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009499
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009500 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009501 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009502 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009503 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009504 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009505 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009506
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009507 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009508
9509 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009510 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009511 continue;
9512 }
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009513
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009514 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattnere3eda252007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009515 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009516 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009517
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009518 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009519 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc6509f42002-12-05 22:41:53 +00009520 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
9521
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009522 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009523 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009524 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009525 continue;
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009526 }
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009527
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009528 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
9529 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9530 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
9531 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
9532 if (UserParent != BB) {
9533 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
9534 // See if the user is one of our successors.
9535 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
9536 if (*SI == UserParent) {
9537 UserIsSuccessor = true;
9538 break;
9539 }
9540
9541 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
9542 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
9543 // otherwise), we can keep going.
9544 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
9545 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
9546 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
9547 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
9548 }
9549 }
9550
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009551 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009552#ifndef NDEBUG
9553 std::string OrigI;
9554#endif
9555 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009556 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner0b18c1d2002-05-10 15:38:35 +00009557 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009558 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009559 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009560 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
9561 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009562
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009563 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
9564 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
9565
9566 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009567 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009568 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009569
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009570 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
9571 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009572
9573 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
9574 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009575 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
9576
9577 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
9578 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
9579 ++InsertPos;
9580
9581 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009582
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009583 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
9584 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009585 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerb643a9e2004-05-01 23:19:52 +00009586
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009587 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
9588 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009589 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009590
9591 // Erase the old instruction.
9592 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009593 } else {
Evan Chenga4ed8a52007-03-27 16:44:48 +00009594#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009595 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
9596 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chenga4ed8a52007-03-27 16:44:48 +00009597#endif
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009598
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009599 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
9600 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009601 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
9602 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
9603 // use counts.
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009604 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009605
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009606 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009607 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009608 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009609 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009610 } else {
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009611 AddToWorkList(I);
9612 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009613 }
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009614 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009615 Changed = true;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009616 }
9617 }
9618
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009619 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009620 return Changed;
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009621}
9622
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009623
9624bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009625 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
9626
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009627 bool EverMadeChange = false;
9628
9629 // Iterate while there is work to do.
9630 unsigned Iteration = 0;
9631 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
9632 EverMadeChange = true;
9633 return EverMadeChange;
9634}
9635
Brian Gaeke38b79e82004-07-27 17:43:21 +00009636FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009637 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009638}
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +00009639